[go: up one dir, main page]
More Web Proxy on the site http://driver.im/

WO1997009835A1 - Wireless communication system - Google Patents

Wireless communication system Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO1997009835A1
WO1997009835A1 PCT/US1996/014019 US9614019W WO9709835A1 WO 1997009835 A1 WO1997009835 A1 WO 1997009835A1 US 9614019 W US9614019 W US 9614019W WO 9709835 A1 WO9709835 A1 WO 9709835A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
base station
cellular base
cordless cellular
mobile station
mobile
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US1996/014019
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Keith Jarett
Roland E. Williams
Michael A. Raffel
Roderick Nelson
Ileana A. Leuca
Tony S. Lee
Christopher G. Lawrence
Masud Kibra
David R. Glass
Michael E. Bamburak
Original Assignee
At & T Wireless Services, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by At & T Wireless Services, Inc. filed Critical At & T Wireless Services, Inc.
Priority to CA002231255A priority Critical patent/CA2231255C/en
Priority to EP96946386A priority patent/EP0935893A4/en
Priority to JP9527157A priority patent/JPH11512913A/en
Publication of WO1997009835A1 publication Critical patent/WO1997009835A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W76/00Connection management
    • H04W76/10Connection setup
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W16/00Network planning, e.g. coverage or traffic planning tools; Network deployment, e.g. resource partitioning or cells structures
    • H04W16/18Network planning tools
    • H04W16/20Network planning tools for indoor coverage or short range network deployment
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W40/00Communication routing or communication path finding
    • H04W40/24Connectivity information management, e.g. connectivity discovery or connectivity update
    • H04W40/248Connectivity information update
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W48/00Access restriction; Network selection; Access point selection
    • H04W48/18Selecting a network or a communication service
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W60/00Affiliation to network, e.g. registration; Terminating affiliation with the network, e.g. de-registration
    • H04W60/04Affiliation to network, e.g. registration; Terminating affiliation with the network, e.g. de-registration using triggered events
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W8/00Network data management
    • H04W8/26Network addressing or numbering for mobility support
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W84/00Network topologies
    • H04W84/02Hierarchically pre-organised networks, e.g. paging networks, cellular networks, WLAN [Wireless Local Area Network] or WLL [Wireless Local Loop]
    • H04W84/10Small scale networks; Flat hierarchical networks
    • H04W84/105PBS [Private Base Station] network
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W88/00Devices specially adapted for wireless communication networks, e.g. terminals, base stations or access point devices
    • H04W88/02Terminal devices
    • H04W88/06Terminal devices adapted for operation in multiple networks or having at least two operational modes, e.g. multi-mode terminals
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02DCLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES IN INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES [ICT], I.E. INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES AIMING AT THE REDUCTION OF THEIR OWN ENERGY USE
    • Y02D30/00Reducing energy consumption in communication networks
    • Y02D30/70Reducing energy consumption in communication networks in wireless communication networks

Definitions

  • the invention relates to a digital wireless communication system.
  • the invention relates to cordless telephones and cellular networks. Background
  • a common type of wireless communication is the communication which occurs between a cordless telephone handset and its associated base unit within a limited distance range around the user's home or business.
  • Cordless telephones typically operate over a radio frequency (RF) portion of the spectrum set aside for general public use.
  • RF radio frequency
  • the power of the cordless phone signal is lower than other communication signals, because the signal needs to only be transmitted between the cordless handset and the associated base unit within the home or business of the user. Therefore, there is no user license from the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) required to operate a cordless telephone.
  • FCC Federal Communications Commission
  • the communication is carried from the associated base unit along a landline on the public telephone network to the connecting party; therefore the cost of the telephone call is regulated by the LEC which owns the public switched telephone network (PSTN).
  • PSTN public switched telephone network
  • Another method of wireless communication is a regional cellular communication network which is operated by a cellular operator to enable the transmission of voice and data from a mobile station to a cellular base station over a specific band of frequencies, e.g., 824-849 MHz and 869-894 MHz, under license by the FCC.
  • the bands are generally broken up into transmission channels and reception channels which each employ different bands of frequencies in the cellular spectrum.
  • Cellular transmissions from the base station to the mobile station occupies the spectrum between 824 and 849 MHz with each transmission channel occupying about 30 KHz.
  • Cellular reception from the mobile stations to the base stations generally occupy the spectrum between 869 and 894 MHz with each reception channel occupying about 30 KHz.
  • each of the transmission and reception bands are divided between two cellular service providers in each market and are referred to as "A" and "B" bands.
  • each provider operates four hundred and sixteen pairs of transmission and reception frequency channels on which to provide service. Twenty-one of the four hundred and sixteen frequency channels pairs are ordinarily used as control channels to send control signals from the base station to the mobile station, thus only three hundred and ninety-five channels are actually available to transmit calls between the cellular base station and mobile station.
  • the cellular service provider enlists subscribers who are authorized to communicate via the regional cellular network. Each subscriber must purchase a mobile station or handset which is capable of communication with the regional cellular network. The handset, at the time of manufacture, is assigned an electronic serial number (ESN).
  • ESN electronic serial number
  • the ESN is generally stored in the permanent memory, such as an EEPROM, in the handset.
  • the subscriber registers the mobile station with the regional cellular network and the mobile station is assigned a mobile identification number (MIN) by which the mobile station can be accessed.
  • MIN mobile identification number
  • handsets have been disclosed which are capable of switching between communication with a cellular network and with an RF cordless telephone unit. Once the handset is in the proximity of the cordless telephone unit, the telephone unit is capable of receiving calls from both the public switched telephone network (via the RF cordless telephone unit) and the regional cellular network.
  • a handset that can communicate with both cellular and RF cordless base stations requires some significant additional hardware and software.
  • a handset that can communicate with both types of base stations requires one transceiver that can communicate with cordless frequencies and one transceiver that can communicate with cellular frequencies as well as separate interface hardware between each transceiver and the main handset controlling hardware.
  • the main handset controlling hardware must be able to recognize and communicate with the different communications protocols required to communicate with the RF cordless telephone base station and with the cellular networks.
  • the additional hardware required to communicate with both base stations increases the size and the weight of the handset. Further, the additional hardware increases the cost of the handset in a highly price-competitive market.
  • the preferred embodiment of the present invention comprises a wireless communication system.
  • the wireless communication system is capable of communicating with a cellular network compatible mobile unit, also referred to as a mobile station herein.
  • the cordless cellular base station also referred to as a subregio ⁇ al base station, is preferably connected to a landline on a public switched telephone network and is assigned a landline number or phone number.
  • the mobile station is registered with a cellular network and is assigned a mobile identification number.
  • the mobile station is capable of communication with both a conventional regional cellular base station and to the cordless cellular base station utilizing the same cellular frequency range and communications protocol.
  • the mobile station When the mobile station is communicating with the cellular network, it is referred to as being in the regional cellular service mode.
  • the mobile station of the present invention advantageously communicates with the autonomous base station and with the regional cellular base stations of the cellular network utilizing the same frequency range and the same communications protocol.
  • the communications protocol that is utilized is compliant with the IS-136, parts one and two, air interface standard which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • the IS- 136, parts one and two, standard is available from the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Dept., 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. This standard provides in part for TDMA (time division multiple access) digital communications and is well known to those of skill in the art.
  • the IS- 136 standard is designed to ensure compatibility between cellular mobile telecommunication systems so that a mobile station can obtain service in any cellular system manufactured in accordance with the standard. Since the mobile station communicates with the cordless cellular base station and with the regional cellular base stations of the cellular network utilizing the same frequency range and the same communications protocol, the mobile station may be manufactured using similar hardware, such as a digital transceiver, and similar software to communicate with both the cordless cellular base station and the cellular network. Therefore, the overall size and the weight of the mobile station is not increased compared to conventional cellular telephones which are compatible with the IS- 136 standard.
  • the cost of the mobile station of the preferred embodiment is not much higher than conventional IS- 136 compliant mobile stations.
  • the cordless cellular base station is able to communicate with the mobile station and act as a conduit between the mobile station and the public switched telephone network.
  • the mobile station despite the fact the mobile station is IS-136 compliant and can communicate with both analog and digital regional cells, the mobile station preferably communicates with the cordless cellular base station utilizing a digital control channel and corresponding digital traffic channels.
  • a digital channels rather than analog and digital channels for communication with the mobile station, the hardware and software required to operate the cordless cellular base station is further reduced and thus the manufacturing costs are reduced.
  • the mobile station automatically registers with the cordless cellular base station when the mobile station comes into proximity with the cordless cellular base station.
  • the cordless cellular base station As the number of cordless cellular base station users increases it becomes more likely that at least some cordless cellular base stations will be operating in close proximity to one another. With base stations present in adjoining houses, for example, it is not desirable to enable automatic registration for all mobile station users that come into proximity with a cordless cellular base station, because it is possible for one neighbor to inadvertently automatically register with another neighbor's cellular base station.
  • the automatic registration feature of the present invention allows the cordless cellular base station to restrict automatic registration to those users who have been previously pre-registered with a particular cordless cellular base station.
  • preregistratio ⁇ before automatic registration occurs, accidental automatic registration with a nearby cordless cellular base station is prevented while still providing the convenience of automatic registration for frequent users.
  • the mobile station will not attempt to automatically register with a cordless cellular base station unless it has previously registered with that cordless cellular base station and knows on which channels to look for the cordless cellular base station.
  • the cordless cellular base station maintains a cordless cellular base station registration list in a semipermanent portion of memory which stores the mobile system identification number of the mobile stations which have been previously been granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station.
  • a mobile station which is not presently involved in a call comes within range of a cordless cellular base station with which it has previously registered, in accordance with the preferred embodiment, it automatically switches from regional cellular service mode to cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention.
  • the cordless cellular base station can process up to two active mobile stations at the same time.
  • the cordless cellular base station bridges the audio signal for the two mobile stations together such that each of the mobile stations is acting like an extension on a normal landline.
  • the cordless cellular base station is designed to operate in the residential home or small office environment. This active RF environment can be potentially very noisy because there may be no dedicated frequency spectrum allocated for the cordless cellular base station operation coupled with the fact that the frequency usage is not explicitly coordinated with the regional cellular network planning.
  • the cordless cellular base station has to co-exist in the same cellular band used by the regional cellular network and views the regional cellular network as a source of background interference.
  • the cordless cellular base station attempts to avoid the potential interference by the cellular network by choosing frequencies which, as far as the cordless cellular base station can determine, are not being used by nearby regional cells or by other nearby cordless cellular base stations.
  • the cordless cellular base station implements an avoidance mechanism which scans the frequencies in the cellular band and determines the best and next-best cellular frequencies for communication with the cellular network at all times.
  • the cordless cellular base station measures the potential interference on each channel and uses the interference measurements to form a score which is used in making the choice of an operating frequency. By selecting a frequency from those with the lowest interference scores, and by using appropriate channel abandonment thresholds, the cordless cellular base station attempts to avoid transmitting on any frequency which is already in use nearby the public or private cellular network or by other cordless cellular base stations within range. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station selects for its initial operational frequency, the frequency with the lowest interference score. The cordless cellular base station randomly selects for its backup frequencies, a specified number of downlink frequencies whose scores are below a high threshold value (Ht).
  • Ht high threshold value
  • the cordless cellular base station Depending upon whether a call is in progress or whether a primary mobile station is registered, if the interference score of the current operational frequency rises above a first low threshold (Lt) or above the high threshold (Ht), the cordless cellular base station automatically switches its operational frequency to the first backup frequency as described in more detail below.
  • the cordless cellular base station also removes backup frequencies from the back-up frequency list if the interference score for that backup frequency rises above the high threshold (Ht).
  • the cordless cellular base station needs to locate a specified number of frequencies having score values below the high threshold value (Ht).
  • the cordless cellular base station in order to make the above measurements, is designed to only transmit a half rate digital control channel (DCCH). Therefore, time slot 4 of the TDMA frame is not used to transmit DCCH information.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the receiver When there are no calls being processed by the cordless cellular base station, the receiver will be silent on timeslot 5 of the receive time frame; and if the transmitter does not transmit any information on timeslot 4 of the transmit time frame, the cordless cellular base station will not be generating any of its own interference and thus can make an accurate measurement of the interference generated on its own channel.
  • the cordless cellular base station performs interference measurements on both its receive or uplink frequencies and on its transmit or downlink frequencies.
  • Figure 1 is a schematic block diagram of a cordless cellular system of the preferred embodiment in communication with a cellular network and a public switched telephone network and shown in use with a cellular network compatible mobile unit.
  • Figure 2 is a partial schematic block diagram of a cordless cellular system of the preferred embodiment in communication with a plurality of cellular network compatible mobile units and a public switched telephone network.
  • Figure 3 is a block diagram of the cordless cellular base station hardware of the preferred embodiment.
  • Figure 4 is a schematic diagram of the TDMA time slot usage for a cordless cellular base station receive frame and for a cordless cellular base station transmit frame.
  • Figure 5 is a block diagram of the mobile station hardware of the preferred embodiment.
  • Figure 6 is a schematic diagram of a memory storage table in the mobile station which stores data regarding certain cordless cellular base stations with which the mobile station communicates.
  • Figure 7 is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with the cordless cellular base station initial authorization feature.
  • Figure 8 is a schematic diagram of the registration list which is maintained by the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 9 is a diagram illustrating the communication between the cordless cellular base station and the mobile station associated with an initial registration of a mobile station.
  • Figure 10 is a flow chart illustrating the steps that the cordless cellular base station takes to process an initial registration request.
  • Figure 11 is a fiow chart illustrating the steps that the mobile station takes to determine its location before attempting automatic registration with a cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 12 is a flow chart illustrating the automatic registration of a mobile station to a cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 13 is a flow chart illustrating the network update attempt procedure of the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 14a is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with one embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network update of forwarding feature.
  • Figure 14b is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with an alternate embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network update of forwarding feature.
  • Figure 15 is a schematic block diagram of the communications between the cordless cellular base station and the cellular network to forward calls for the mobile stations serviced by the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 16 is a schematic block diagram illustrating one embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 17 is a schematic block diagram illustrating a second embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 18 is a schematic block diagram illustrating a third embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station.
  • Figure 19a is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with one embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network cancellation of forwarding feature.
  • Figure 19b is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with an alternate embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network cancellation of forwarding feature.
  • Figure 20 is a graph of the staircase function used to translate the noise plus interference power level into a score increment.
  • Figure 21 is a graph of the variations in an exemplary interference score over time.
  • Figure 22 is a drawing of an exemplary score of a variety of frequencies over time.
  • FIG. 1 and 2 comprises a cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station is capable of communicating with a cellular network compatible mobile station 12.
  • the cordless cellular base station algor referred to as a limited or selective access base station, is connected to a landline 14 on a public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15 and is assigned a landline identification number (LLN) or telephone number.
  • PSTN public switched telephone network
  • LPN landline identification number
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is assigned an electronic serial number at the time of manufacture for identification purposes.
  • the electronic serial number is generally stored in permanent memory in the cordless cellular base station so the serial number cannot be tampered with by unauthorized personnel.
  • the mobile station 12 is registered with a cellular network 16 and is assigned a mobile station identification number (MIN) which is the telephone number of the mobile station.
  • MIN mobile station identification number
  • the mobile station at the time of manufacture, is assigned an electronic serial number (ESN).
  • ESN is generally stored in the permanent memory, in the mobile station.
  • the cellular network 16 is connected to the public switched telephone network to route calls to/from callers on the cellular network 16 from/to callers on the public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15.
  • PSTN public switched telephone network
  • the mobile stations 12 are capable of communicating with both cellular base stations 18 on the cellular network 16 and with cordless cellular base stations 10.
  • a mobile station 12 When a mobile station 12 is communicating with the cellular network 16, it is referred to as being in regional cellular service mode.
  • a mobile station 12 When a mobile station 12 is communicating with the cordless cellular base station 10, it is referred to as being in cordless telephone landline service mode.
  • the mobile station 12 When a mobile station 12 comes within range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered, as described in more detail below and in accordance with the preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 automatically switches from the regional cellular service mode to the cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention. Once the mobile station 12 has confirmed with the cordless cellular base station 10 that the mobile station 12 has switched to cordless landline service mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 communicates with the cellular network 16 to provide a call forwarding update message. The call forwarding update message requests that the cellular network 16 route all calls for the mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • all calls placed on the mobile station 12 are sent through the cordless cellular base station 10 to the associated landline 14 and out onto the PSTN 15.
  • handoff of telephone calls between the regional cellular network 16 and cordless cellular base station 10 environments is enabled.
  • the call is automatically switched through the cordless cellular base station 10 and its associated landline 14 to the cellular network 16.
  • the cellular network 16 then routes the call through the cellular base station 10 to the user's mobile station 12 in a manner similar to the handoff procedure between adjacent cells in a conventional cellular system.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is informed during the initial authorization message which types of registration/deregistration activities for which the network 16 wants to be informed.
  • types of deregistration events for which the network 16 may want to be contacted are: when the mobile station 12 is turned off, i.e., a power down deregistration or due to a manual cancellation of the cordless service mode, i.e., forced deregistration.
  • the mobile station 12 When the mobile station 12 severs contact with the cordless cellular base station 10 for reasons other than powering off, the mobile station 12 may register with the local regional cellular base station of the regional cellular network 16. Once the mobile station 12 is registered with the regional cell, calls to the users mobile identification number are directiy routed by the cellular network 16 to the mobile station 12.
  • CCBS Cordless Cellular Base Station
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 communicates over the land line 14 and with the mobile station 12 using a digital cellular transceiver.
  • the cordless cellular base station uses time division multiple access (TDMA) communication to communicate with the mobile station 12.
  • TDMA time division multiple access
  • the hardware of the cordless cellular base station 10 is very similar to the hardware used for a mobile station, however the functionality of the cordless cellular base station 16 is similar to a base station for a regional cell.
  • the most significant differences between the cordless cellular base station and a typical base station are that the cordless cellular base station preferably has only one transceiver (permitting the use of only one set of transmit and receive frequency channel at one time) and that it supports only digital traffic.
  • the CCBS comprises a microprocessor or a microcontroller 20, an associated memory storage area 21, a baseband modem 22, a cellular transceiver 23, a transmit (Tx) antenna 24, a receive (Rx) antenna 25, user interface hardware 26, a modem 27, a switch 28 and standard telephone interface hardware 29.
  • the processor 20 is in communication with the memory 21, the user interface 26, the modem 27, the baseband modem 22, and the cellular transceiver 23 in a well known way.
  • the processor 20 controls the operation of the radio portion of the cordless cellular base station hardware, i.e., the operation of the baseband modem 22 and cellular transceiver 23.
  • the processor 20 also controls the operation of the call processing tasks and the administrative tasks related to communication with the cellular network 16. Finally, the processor 20 controls the user interface 26.
  • the digital cellular transceiver 23 and processor 20 together communicate with the mobile station utilizing the IS- 136 standard air interface communications protocol.
  • the associated memory storage area 21 comprises both permanent and temporary memory storage capabilities.
  • the baseband modem 22 is preferably implemented using a digital signal processor (DSP).
  • DSP digital signal processor
  • the baseband modem 22 used in the cordless cellular base station 10 provides the same type of function as is used in local cellular base stations 18.
  • the baseband modem 22 is used to implement the time division multiple access (TDMA) protocol in accordance with the IS- 136 standard.
  • TDMA time division multiple access
  • the baseband modem 22 performs the coding of the voice signals which digitally compresses and encodes the analog voice messages to/from the landline from/to the mobile station for faster transmission across the cellular channel, as known to those of skill in the art.
  • VSELP coding is used; however, other compressing and coding schemes known to those of skill in the art, such as the International Telecommunications Union (ITU) compression and coding schemes, may be utilized.
  • the baseband modem 22 performs the signal processing functions associated with voice detection to differentiate between noise and voice signals and echo cancellation to alleviate echoes picked up by the microphone in the mobile stations 12 which are common signal processing functions performed by base stations.
  • the cellular transceiver 23 comprises a transmitter (Tx) 30 and a receiver (Rx) 31.
  • the cellular transceiver 23 is a digital transceiver.
  • the digital cellular transceiver 23 is a time division multiple access (TDMA) transceiver.
  • the transmitter 30 is the similar to the transmitter that is used in the mobile station 12.
  • the functionality of the transmitter is compliant with the IS-138 minimum performance requirements for a digital base station standard except for the exceptions listed below.
  • the IS- 138 standard is well known to those of skill in the art and is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • the IS- 138 standard can be obtained through the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Department, 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006.
  • TIA Telecommunications Industry Association
  • the transmitter of the cordless cellular base station emits much less power than a standard cellular base station, since the output power of the cordless cellular base station 10 is designed to communicate only with mobile stations 12 in a small surrounding area.
  • the transmitter 30 transmits at an output power of 6.3 mW. In another embodiment, the transmitter 30 transmits at an output power of approximately 10 W.
  • the receiver 31 is similar to the receivers that are used in a standard cellular telephone, in that the receiver 31 of the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to receive at a fairly high sensitivity in the mobile receive band in order to be able to search for other nearby base station signals.
  • a single receiver is used to both receive the mobile station transmissions and to take noise measurements which saves in the cost of the cordless cellular base station and reduces the size of the cordless cellular base station.
  • the dynamic range of the receiver is approximately 70 dB, that is, the receiver can receive signals which are within a 70 dB range.
  • the sensitivity of the receiver 31 on the cordless cellular base station 10 must be significantly less than the sensitivity to measure the noise in the surrounding environment. This is because the mobile station is expected to be used very close to the base station. Thus, when the receiver 31 is waiting to receive a mobile station transmission, the sensitivity of the receiver is less to enable it to receive higher powered transmissions.
  • the 70 dB dynamic range of the receiver is scaled to receive transmissions from the mobile station 12 in the -20 dBm to -90 dBm range.
  • the sensitivity of the receiver 31 is increased to enable it to receive lower power transmissions.
  • the 70 dB dynamic range of the receiver 31 is scaled to receive transmissions in the 46 dBm to -116 dBm range.
  • the CCBS uses a non-linear front end receiver to provide increased dynamic range. As will be recognized by those of skill in the art, the fact that the CCBS does not require an equalizer enables the non-linear front end receiver to be easily substituted for the preferred receiver described above.
  • the hardware and software of the cordless cellular base station 10 is less complicated and therefore, the cost to manufacture the cordless cellular base station 10 is reduced.
  • the IS-136 standard calls for base station and mobile stations that operate in TDMA digital mode on the digital channels and in an analog mode on analog channels. While it is preferred to provide cordless cellular base station that operates only in a digital mode on the digital channels, it is contemplated that a cordless cellular base station could be provided such that it operates in both analog and digital modes.
  • the transmit (Tx) antenna 24 and receive (Rx) antenna 25 are simple antennas, since the coverage area for the cordless cellular base station 10 is small.
  • the transmit antenna 24 and receive antenna 25 are separate antennas which are physically separated on the cordless cellular base station 10 . Further, their signals are transmitted to the transceiver 23 along separate paths to eliminate the need for a duplexer, thereby simplifying the design and reducing manufacturing costs.
  • a common antenna for both transmission and receive functions may be advantageous and in the common antenna embodiment a duplexer is added to the cordless cellular base station hardware. Duplexers are well known devices that permit signais of different frequencies to be sent and received at the same time over the same antenna.
  • the transmit and receive antennas are internal antennas that do not extend outside of the cordless cellular base station.
  • the user interface hardware 26 is capable of providing an interface between a keypad 32 and a display 33.
  • the keypad 32 includes the standard telephone twelve-key keypad. In other embodiments, the keypad 32 may include additional function keys.
  • the display 33 is preferably an LCD display capable of displaying a variety of types of information to the user. The display 33 in a simpler embodiment may include a plurality of seven-segment displays or one or more simple LEDs.
  • the standard telephone interface hardware 29 is utilized to communicate with the landline 14 and the PSTN 15 utilizing control signals and a communications protocol which are commonly known in the art.
  • the standard telephone interface hardware 29 includes a standard four-wire-to-two wire hybrid device to convert the signals on four wires from the cordless cellular base station hardware to the two wire standard of landline communication.
  • the telephone interface hardware 29 provides ring detection and the closing of a subscriber loop under command of the controller 20.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 appears to the PSTN 15 as if it were a standard 2500 series telephone.
  • the base station 10 advantageously supports both pulse and DTMF dialing.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 also includes a standard data modem 27 for use in transmitting data over an ordinary telephone line. This permits a modem link to be set up between the cordless cellular base station 10 and another system using its associated landline 14.
  • the cordless cellular base station hardware includes a power supply 34.
  • the power supply 34 comprises the circuits to define and regulate voltages supplied to the above-referenced hardware elements of the cordless cellular base station 10. At least one connection is made to obtain power from a main source, such as a wall socket in a home.
  • the power supply 34 may also include an alternate connection to which a battery may be connected and charged.
  • Cordless Cellular Base Station Operation Referring back to Figures 1 and 2, the cordless cellular base station 10 supports the following functions, which are described in more detail hereafter.
  • a network authorization procedure initializes the communication between the cordless cellular base station 10 and the cellular network 16.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 enables registration of mobile stations 12 for use with the cordless cellular base station 10. Registration of a mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10, as described in more detail below, enables the mobile station 12 to receive calls addressed to its mobile station identification number at the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 maintains a list of the mobile stations 12 most recently granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station 12 while the mobile station 12 is listed on the registration list of a particular cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 automatically registers with the cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 comes into proximity with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • This automatic registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10 occurs because the mobile station 12 stores information about the regional cellular network service 16 in the vicinity of the cordless cellular base station as described in more detail below.
  • the mobile station 12 recognizes that it is located in the portion of the regional cellular network 16 which is near the cordless cellular base station 10 that it has recently registered with, the mobile station begins to search for the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is always transmitting a digital control channel signal (DCCH), which is well known to those of skill in the art, for the mobile station 12 to locate.
  • DCCH digital control channel signal
  • an automatic registration procedure which is described in more detail below, is invoked which enables the mobile station 12 to receive calls directed to its mobile station identification number at the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is advantageously able to support the registration of up to ten mobile stations 12 at a given time, i.e., up to ten mobile stations 12 may be communicating with the cordless cellular base station 10 to have the regional cellular network 16 forward calls for their respective mobile stations 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. If a mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is not on a call, the mobile station 12 is considered to be in a "standby" state, that is, it is standing by ready to transmit or receive a call.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 pages all of the registered mobile stations 12, using the paging processes known to those of skill in the art, which is the same as a cellular base station 18 paging a mobile station 12, and all of the mobile stations 12 will "ring" indicating an incoming call.
  • any one of the mobile station users depresses the send key on the mobile station handset 12 and will be connected through the cordless cellular base station 10 to accept the call.
  • the mobile station 12 accepts a call by pressing the send key or transmits a call, the mobile station 12 is considered to be in an "active" state, that is, it is actively processing a call.
  • the cordless cellular base station of the preferred embodiment can support two "active" mobile stations, that is, up to two mobile stations can communicate with each other or with a caller on the landline through the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the first two mobile stations to answer a call will be connected to the call.
  • the remaining mobile stations are locked out and any attempt by any of the mobile stations to answer the call will result in an error indication by the phone to the user.
  • call processing hardware and software can be added to the cordless cellular base station 10, as known to those of skill in the art.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 can support two mobile stations 12 because of the manner that the cordless cellular base station 10 uses the time slots of a single TDMA frame to transmit and receive information.
  • the TDMA signal has six time slots, referred to as time slot 1 to time slot 6 (37-42) respectively, and as illustrated in Figure 4.
  • time slot 1 to time slot 6 37-42
  • Figure 4 time slot 4
  • Figure 4 time slot 4
  • the following information is received by the mobile station 12 in each of the time slots (37-42), respectively.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 receives the digital control channel (DCCH) messages, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, from the mobile station 12 in the same manner that a digital cellular base station in a regional cell 18 receives DCCH messages from a mobile station 12.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the DCCH messages contain the information that the mobile station 12 must exchange with the cordless cellular base station 10 to maintain registration with the cordless cellular base station 12.
  • time slot 2 (38) and time slot 5 (41) the cordless cellular base station 10 receives voice data from a second mobile station (MS2).
  • time slot 3 (39) and time slot 6 (42) the cordless cellular base station 10 receives voice data from a first mobile station (MS1).
  • time slot 4 no data is received from the mobile station 12 in the cordless cellular base station 10 which is shown as an open time slot.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits digital control channel (DCCH) messages, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, in the same manner that a digital cellular base station in a regional cellular network transmits DCCH information.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the DCCH messages contain the information that the mobile station 12 looks for to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 when it recognizes that it is in proximity to it.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits voice data to a second mobile station (MS2).
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits voice data to a first mobile station (MS1). Since the digital control channel (DCCH) is preferably a half-rate digital control channel, the DCCH does not have to be transmitted in time slot 4 (40). Therefore, time slot 4 usually only transmits the synch word which helps mobile stations synchronize their transmission with the cordless cellular base station.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 randomly transmits an idle code in addition to the synch word on time slot four. By occasionally transmitting an idle code at random time intervals on time slot 4, the probability that the CCBS will be detected by any of the cordless cellular base stations which are transmitting in sync is increased. For the remainder of the time, timeslot 4 (40) is silent besides the transmission of the synch word to gather noise information regarding the environment in which the cordless cellular base station 10 resides.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits an idle code in Time Slot 4 (40) instead of being silent to notify nearby cordless cellular base stations 10 of its existence during this time slot 40.
  • the average rate of these transmissions is preferably between one in two hundred fifty-six and one in eight TDMA frames.
  • the frames in which the idle code is transmitted are selected by either a non-deterministic process or by a pseudo-random decision process that yields different selection patterns for different cordless cellular base stations 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 When the mobile station 12 moves out of the range of the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically sends a message to the regional cellular network 16 to cancel the call forwarding of phone calls addressed to the mobile station identification number of the mobile station 12, as described in more detail below. In the preferred embodiment, if the mobile station 12 is on a call, the call is dropped and the mobile station 12 will have to reinitiate the call through the regional cellular network 16. In an alternate embodiment, the call is maintained by automatically forwarding the call to the mobile station 12 through the regional cellular network 16. In either case, after the mobile station 12 is no longer in the range of the cordless cellular network 16, the mobile station 12 automatically registers with the regional cellular network 16 to accept calls in the traditional cellular service manner.
  • the hardware of the mobile station 12, as illustrated in Figure 5, comprises a processor 46, an associated memory storage area 47, a digital cellular transceiver 50, an analog cellular transceiver 52, user interface hardware 44, and handset I/O control logic 45.
  • the digital cellular transceiver 50 and the analog cellular transceiver 52 are actually incorporated into the same cellular transceiver device as in the cordless cellular base station, however, for simplicity of understanding are shown as two separate devices in Figure 5.
  • the processor 46 is in communication with each of the above indicated elements.
  • the associated memory storage area 47 comprises both permanent and temporary memory storage capabilities.
  • the digital cellular transceiver 50 comprises a receiver (Rx) 48 and a transmitter (Tx) 49.
  • the digital cellular transceiver 50 is a time division multiple access (TDMA) transceiver.
  • the analog cellular transceiver 52 comprises a receiver (Rx) 53 and a transmitter (Tx) 54.
  • the user interface hardware 50 is capable of providing an interface between a keypad 55 and a display 56.
  • the keypad 55 includes at least the standard telephone twelve-key keypad. In other embodiments, the keypad 55 may include additional function keys.
  • the display 56 is preferably an LCD display capable of displaying a variety of types of information to the user.
  • the display 56 in a simpler embodiment, may include a plurality of seven-segment displays.
  • the handset I/O control logic 45 provides an interface between a standard telephone microphone pickup 60 and speaker 59 on a conventional handset of a mobile station 12 as is commonly known to those in the art.
  • the mobile station 12 meets all of the requirements of the IS-137 performance requirements for a mobile station standard, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • the IS-137 standard can be obtained through the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Department, 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. Mobile Station Operation Referring back to Figures 1-2, the mobile station 12 preferably comprises a dual-mode cellular handset that is capable of accessing either digital or analog channels in a regional cell 18 of the cellular network 16.
  • the mobile station 12 communicates with the cellular network 16, i.e., with the local cells 18, and with the cordless cellular base station 10 utilizing the same cellular frequency ranges and utilizing a single communications protocol.
  • the mobile station 12 utilizes the IS-136 air interface standard, to communicate with both the cellular network 16 and the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the IS-136 standard forms a compatibility standard for time division multiple access (TDMA) digital cellular mobile telecommunication systems to ensure that a mobile station 12 can obtain service in any cellular system manufactured in accordance with the standard.
  • TDMA time division multiple access
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 uses only the TDMA digital protocol from the IS- 136 standard and thus, the mobile station 12 only utilizes its digital transceiver 50 ( Figure 5) to communicate with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station may also be compliant with other communications standards such as such as those standards which are compliant with 1.9 GHz operation, such as provisional standard PN-3388 which is also available from the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA).
  • TIA Telecommunications Industry Association
  • the mobile station 12 has an initial preference for its last network registration; that is, when the mobile station 12 is powered ON, the mobile station 12 automatically synchronizes to is last operating frequency and attempts to register with the control channel on that frequency. If it fails to locate a control channel on that frequency, the mobile station will scan the other frequencies to locate the best control channel. Most likely, the mobile station will end up registering with the closest regional cellular base station 18 in the cellular network 16. After it has registered with the regional cellular network, as described in more detail below, when the mobile station 12 comes into proximity with a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges, the mobile station 12 automatically deregisters from the regional cellular network 16 and registers with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station 12 stores information regarding the cellular service in the area surrounding the cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has recently registered.
  • the mobile station 12 constantly compares the information about the regional cell 18 it is currently in to see if it is a cell that is likely to contain one of the cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has most recently registered. If it is in a regional cell 18 that is likely to contain a cordless cellular base station 10 that it has recently registered with, it attempts to locate that cordless cellular base station 10 utilizing information that it has stored about the operating parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station 12 includes a certain portion of its memory 47 ( Figure 5) that is dedicated to the semi-permanent storage of the operating frequency and other information related to one or more cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has recently registered.
  • the mobile station 12 semi-permanently retains, in an EEPROM, a cordless cellular base station storage table 78, as illustrated in Figure 6, which stores information about three cordless cellular base stations with which it has previously registered. While storage for three cordless cellular base stations 10 is currently preferred, it is contemplated that appropriate applications storage for additional cordless cellular base stations 10 is possible.
  • a top row 80 holds data for a "primary" cordless cellular base station.
  • the "primary" cordless cellular base station is, for example, the cordless cellular base station 10 in the user's home or office, which is most often accessed by the user and is responsible for the bills associated with the subscription to this service.
  • the user defines which cordless cellular base station is the "primary" base station.
  • the user enters a specified keystroke procedure, which may advantageously be entering the number 1 key followed by the # key on the mobile station keypad, to allow the user to designate the cordless cellular base station 10 currently in use as the "primary" cordless cellular base station.
  • the second and third rows 82, 84 advantageously hold data for the two most recently used non-primary cordless cellular base stations 10 in the order of most recent use.
  • the mobile station 12 maintains the information for the primary cordless cellular base station at all times in the top row 80.
  • the mobile station 12 manages the ordering of the lower rows, shuffling them as necessary to ensure that the second row 82 has the data for the non-primary cordless cellular base station 10 used most recently, and the third row 84 has the data for the non-primary cordless cellular base station 10 used next most recently.
  • the table 78 is divided into first and second parts 85, 87.
  • the first part 85 of the table 78 stores information about the cordless cellular base station 10, such as the cordless cellular base station identification number and last known operating channel and back-up channel for the cordless cellular base stations 10.
  • the second part 87 of the table 78 stores information about the cellular service for the regional cell
  • the first part 85 of the table 78 preferably includes the following information regarding the cordless cellular base station 10: a Residential System ID (RSID) 86, the operating channel f n 88, and back up channels f 1 ( f 2 , and f 3 90-94 respectively, the country code CC 96 and the system operating code SOC 98.
  • the RSID is a 16-bit serial number that identifies the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the RSID is assigned to the cordless cellular base station by the cellular network 16 during its initial authorization procedure.
  • the RSID 86 is broadcast by the cordless cellular base station 10 over the digital control channel (DCCH) in accordance with the IS- 136 standard for the mobile station 12 to recognize and to attempt to register with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station 12 restores the RSID in the table 78 after the initial registration with the cordless cellular base station 10 to help the mobile station 12 relocate the cordless cellular base station 10 the next time it comes within range.
  • the channel information is the current or last known operating channel fg 88, and three alternative channels f detox f 2 , and f 3 90-94, respectively, on which the cordless cellular base station 10 may operate.
  • the alternate channels are the channels on which the digital control channel (DCCH) for the cordless cellular base station would most likely be detected.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 broadcasts a neighbor list which includes the alternate channels for cordless cellular base station operation.
  • the neighbor list is then stored by the mobile station.
  • the alternate channels are supplied to the mobile station 12 by the cordless cellular base station 10 via data or other delivery packets which are periodically transmitted by the cordless cellular base station 10 over the digital control channel (DCCH), while the mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the country code CC 96 is the country code for the landline 14 to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected.
  • the System Operator Code SOC 98 is the system operator code for the service provider.
  • the McCaw network has its individual code, as do other service providers.
  • the country code CC 96, the System Operator Code SOC 98, and the RSID 86 are referred to herein as the "extended RSID" 100.
  • the mobile station 12 is trying to determine if it has located a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered it compares the "extended RSID" 100 it has stored with the broadcast extended RSID from the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station 12 compares a stored extended RSID 100 against a cordless cellular base station's broadcasted extended RSID for a match, the following rules are used. If the CC 96 of the cordless cellular base station 10 was not previously obtained by the mobile station 12, the mobile station 12 treats this as if the two CCs are known and match. In effect, an unknown CC 96 is treated as a wild card.
  • Using the extended RSID 100 rather than the RSID 86 by itself provides an additional level of protection against inadvertent registration with a cordless cellular base station 10 in the wrong area which happen to have the same RSID as the mobile station 12 has stored. For example, you do not want your mobile station 12 to try to register with a cordless cellular base station 10 of a person in Canada which may have the same RSID 86 as a cordless cellular base station 10 in the United States.
  • the extended RSID 100 thus checking the country code CC 96, the system operating code SOC 98 and the RSID 100, such errors are obviated.
  • the second part 87 of the table 78 includes the following information regarding the regional cell 18 in which the cordless cellular base station 10 exists: a system identifier SID 102 of the cell, a plurality of public service profiles PSP proportion, PSP proportion PSP 2 , and PSP 3 104-110 which further characterize the cell 18.
  • the System Identifier SID 102 is an identification number for a metropolitan area within the cellular network 16 within which the cordless cellular base station 10 is located. Each metropolitan area in the regional cellular network 16 is assigned its own SID 102.
  • the mobile station 12 uses the SID to identify when the mobile station 12 is in an area which is most likely to contain a known cordless cellular base station 10. There may be several cells 18 which operate within the metropolitan area.
  • the Public Service Profile preferably contains, in the case of a digital regional cell, the digital control channel (DCCH) channel number for the regional cell and the 8-bit Digital Verification Color Code (DVCC) number for the regional cell in which the cordless cellular base station was last located.
  • the DVCC is sent by the base station to the mobile station and is coded to form the Coded Digital Verification Color Code (CDVCC).
  • the DVCC is a 12-bit data field which contains the 8-bit DVCC and 4 protection bits generated by the base station.
  • the CDVCC is sent in each time slot to and from the mobile stations and base station.
  • the CDVCC is used to indicate that the correct data to/from the base station from/to the mobile station is being decoded. These numbers are well known to those in the art.
  • the Public Service Profile preferably contains the Analog Control Channel number (ACCH) for the regional cell and the Digital Color Code (DCC) number for the regional cell within which the cordless cellular base station 10 was last located.
  • the DCC is a digital signal transmitted by a base station on a forward analog control channel that is used to detect capture of the appropriate base station by a particular mobile station. These numbers are well known to those of skill in the art.
  • the purpose for storing the Public Service Profile is to have additional information about the regional cellular service in which the desired cordless cellular base station 10 is located, so that it is more likely the correct regional cells will be identified corresponding to the cordless cellular base station.
  • the mobile station 12 is responsible for populating the PSP columns 104-110 of the table 78. In order to be able to do this, in a preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 receives the broadcast neighbor list from the cordless cellular base station 10 and infers the PSPs from the neighbor list.
  • the neighbor list message which is typically broadcast by a base station is specified by the IS-136 standard and includes the ability to designate certain channels as preferred channels, certain channels as non-preferred channels and certain channels as regular channels. A channel designated as a preferred channel would cause the receiving mobile station to switch its operating channel over to this preferred channel. The non-preferred and regular channels do not require such immediate action from the mobile station.
  • the cordless cellular base station takes advantage of this predefined IS- 136 broadcast neighbor list message, but instead of sending information regarding the make up of nearby peer cells over the neighbor list message, the cordless cellular base station sends PSP information regarding the cells which overlap the CCBS coverage area and information regarding the backup channels that the CCBS may choose to switch to.
  • the cordless cellular base station may include additional channels which are not backup channels but are channels that the CCBS wants the mobile station to be aware of. Up to four PSPs are sent over the broadcast neighbor list and are designated as non-preferred channels. The remainder of the neighbor list is made up of the backup channels and other channels which are all indicated as regular channels.
  • the mobile station 12 receives the neighbor list from the cordless cellular base station 10, it extracts the PSP information for those channels which are indicated as non-preferred channels and stores this information in the cordless cellular base station storage table 78.
  • the CCBS determines the channels which are to be included in the neighbor list message as the non- preferred channels by determining the public cells that the CCBS is within or nearby by using the following procedure.
  • the CCBS scans all of the channels in the cellular spectrum and performing received signal strength (RSS) measurements on each channel. It will look at the activity on the channel having the highest RSS measurements to see if the activity on the channel is due to a public digital control channel. If the signal is not due to a public digital control channel, the CCBS will switch move to the channel with the next highest RSS measurement, etc. until a 20 dB threshold is reached.
  • RSS received signal strength
  • the CCBS will store this channel as an active digital control channel for a public cell whose coverage area includes or is near that CCBS is within or nearby.
  • the CCBS will collect the PSP information for up to four active digital control channels for public cells that the CCBS is within or nearby and will send this information in the broadcast neighbor list message.
  • the mobile station 12 collects the Public Service Profile for the regional cell 18 whenever the mobile station enters a new cell 18.
  • the mobile station 12 compares the current and previous collected public service profiles (PSPs) with the previously stored public service profiles and updates the table 78 if one or both of these public service profiles is not already present in table 78.
  • PSPs public service profiles
  • the reason that the public service profile may change is that it is possible that a cordless cellular base station 10 may be located in a place over which the regional ceil which provides service may change, i.e., the cordless cellular base station may be at a location where the service range of up to four adjacent cells overlap.
  • the mobile station 12 By storing up to four public service profiles, no matter which cell is servicing the mobile station 12 as it approaches the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 will still recognize that it needs to try to locate the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the most recently collected public service profile is always stored as PSP 0 .
  • PSP public service profile
  • PSP 2 public service profile which was stored as PSP
  • PSP 2 public service profile which was stored as PSP 2
  • extended Public Service Profile 112 is used herein to mean the combination of the SID 102 and a PSP.
  • the mobile station 12 verifies that the current SID matches the SID of the regional cell 18 containing the cordless cellular base station 10 before checking the PSP.
  • the PSPs are checked in order for a match.
  • the extended PSP 112 must match before the mobile station 12 begins looking for a specific cordless cellular base station 10. For example, the mobile station 12 checks the SID of the cell that it is presently in and compares it to SIDs for each of the cordless cellular base stations 10 that the mobile station 12 is registered with to determine if the mobile station 12 is in a SID that is likely to have a known cordless cellular base station 10. In this way, the mobile station 12 does not look for a specific cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 is roaming in some distant city with an unfamiliar SID.
  • the use of the SID reduces the chance that the mobile station 12 will erroneously attempt to register with a cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 user is in another city or state.
  • the extended PSP also contains the country code, CC, for the country in which the cordless cellular base station resides which prevents the mobile station from searching for the cordless cellular base station when the SID matches but the mobile station is in the wrong country.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 first initially registers with the cellular network 16 in order to authorize its use. In fact, the cordless cellular base station 10 is not operational without the network authorization, as the cellular network 16 provides the cordless cellular base station 10 with certain operational parameters, such as the authorized operating frequency list for its operation.
  • the seller will contact the cellular network 16 and provide it with certain information about the cordless cellular base station 10, such as the electronic serial number of the cordless cellular base station 10, the landline number to which the user plans to hook ⁇ up the cordless cellular base station 10, etc.
  • the seller will also provide the mobile identification number (MIN) of the primary user's mobile station 12 to the cellular network for subscription to the call forwarding feature.
  • MIN mobile identification number
  • the user connects the cordless cellular base station 10 to a telephone jack 58 associated with the user's landline 14 and a power source (not shown), such as a typical wall socket.
  • a power source such as a typical wall socket.
  • the user depresses a network authorization function key 62 on the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically initializes a cellular network authorization procedure.
  • the system could advantageously accept a series of specified numbers and symbols on the telephone keypad ( Figure 3), such as 4648#, as instructions to manually initialize the network authorization procedure.
  • the network authorization procedure for a new cordless cellular base station 10 is described.
  • the processor 46 uses the standard telephone interface hardware 29 on the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 to initiate a call to a preset cellular network authorization phone number, such as a remote network update number, via the landline 14 in a step 64.
  • a preset cellular network authorization phone number such as a remote network update number
  • the cellular network authorization number is stored in semi-permanent memory in the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cellular network 16 After the cellular network (CN) 16 answers the call from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 initiates a modem link in modem setup step 66 with the cordless cellular base station 10 on the landline 14.
  • This modem link can be established using the AT&T 800 Transaction Access Service Option or may be provided by a separate modem pool.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 makes at least two attempts to set up a modem link with the network 16.
  • the modem 27 of the cordless cellular base station 10 and a modem 27 in the cellular network 16 are synchronized, and a modem link is established. At least two attempts are made to establish the modem link.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization request message in step 68.
  • the authorization request message includes the electronic serial number of the cordless cellular base station for identification purposes.
  • the network verifies that the cordless cellular base station 10 which is identified by the electronic serial number is calling from the landline number which was given to the cellular network when the cordless cellular base station was purchased.
  • the cordless cellular base station uses the (CNI) calling number identification feature of the telephone line from the PSTN 15 to verify that the call that is being received is, in fact, on the landline 14 that was stored in the regional cellular system.
  • the cellular network 16 accepts an initial authentication message (AUTH) from the cordless cellular base station 10 and sends an initial authorization message (auth) to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 72.
  • AUTH initial authentication message
  • auth initial authorization message
  • the cellular network 16 downloads certain operational parameters for the cordless cellular base station 10 in the authorization message.
  • the authorization message comprises (a) Primary MIN; (b) CCBS-ID - Password to be used by the CCBS in subsequent communication with the CCBS VLR; (c) Public SID (SID) - the System Identification in which this CCBS should be operating; (d) Residential SID (RSID) - the Residential System Identification which should identify this CCBS; (e) CCBS_Auth_Count - the initial value to use for fraud protection; (f) Registration/Deregistration Flag - an indication to the CCBS which registrations and deregistrations for which the CCBS VLR would like to be informed; (g) Authorization Frequencies - a list of frequencies within which the cellular base station is authorized to operate; (h) Remote Network Update Number 1 (RNUN1) - the number which the CCBS should use for further communication with the CCBS; (i) Remote Network Update Number 2 (RNUN2) - the alternate number which the CCBS should use if the Remote Network Update Number 1 no longer works; (j) LL
  • the operating frequencies are, in a preferred embodiment, a portion of the frequencies in the cellular spectrum. However, the operating frequencies may include all of the frequencies in the cellular spectrum.
  • the authorization power level is the power level at which the CCBS is authorized to operate.
  • the user has the option of the level of service that he or she wants to receive and could be changed a different fee for a different level of service. For example, the user could choose either a lesser area of coverage for the CCBS, a normal area of coverage for the CCBS or an expanded area of coverage for the CCBS wherein each of these coverage areas would have a corresponding authorization or authorized power level.
  • the corresponding authorized power level will be sent to the CCBS in the authorization message.
  • the parameters received during the authorization step are stored in the memory of the cordless cellular base station 10 and are used for operation. Preferably, the parameters are stored in an EEPROM.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of the auth message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 74. Once the return result message is received and the initialization procedure is complete, either the cordless cellular base station 10 or the cellular network 16 releases the call (Release call) in step 76. If any of the above attempts to initialize the cordless cellular base station 10 fail, the initialization procedure is canceled by the cellular network 16 and, the authorization step is reattempted after a certain period of time. If the second attempt fails, the user can recontact the cellular network 16 by placing another call on the landline 14 to the cellular network 16 to request that the initialization procedure be tried over again.
  • the cellular network 16 retains a permanent record of the cordless cellular base station's unique identification password number, the mobile station ID number of the primary mobile station 12 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 and the landline number that is associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • an indicator on the cordless cellular base station 10 is illuminated to signify that the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for use.
  • the network authorization procedure is similar to that described above, except that the user initiates the authorization procedure by calling the cellular network authorization phone number on the user's standard telephone landline 14 and providing the cellular network 16 with the landline number (LLN) to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected.
  • the cellular network (CN) 16 initiates the telephone call (Initial Call) to the landline number on the public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15 to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected.
  • PSTN public switched telephone network
  • the user does not answer the telephone call; instead, the landline communications hardware 29 ( Figure 3) on the cordless cellular base station 10 is allowed to answer the call.
  • the authorization procedure proceeds as described above, by setting up a modem link and following the flow outline in Figure 7.
  • the preferred registration scheme allows the cordless cellular base station 10 to be accessible only to users who have been previously been granted the registration privilege.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 maintains a cordless cellular base station registration list 113 in a semipermanent portion of the memory 21 ( Figure 3) which stores the mobile system identification number of the mobile stations 12 which have been previously been granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station registration list 113 is preferably broken down into first and second parts 114, 115.
  • the mobile station identification numbers MINS of the "primary" mobile stations 12 which are granted automatic registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10 are stored in the first part 114 of the list 113.
  • the primary users are the owners of the cordless cellular base station 10 and are normally the users who are billed for the services of the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station identification numbers MIN of the "non-primary" mobile stations 12 most recently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 are stored in the second part 115 of the list 113.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is advantageously capable of granting automatic registration privileges to a limited number of mobile stations 12 whose MINs are stored in the cordless cellular base station registration list 113.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is capable of granting registration privileges to two primary users and eight non-primary users. However, depending upon the preferred use, the numbers could be less than or greater than those indicated above.
  • the primary users in the first part 114 of the list are preferably not changeable without intervention by an authorized agent or by communication with the regional cellular network 16.
  • the second part 115 of the list are preferably not changeable without intervention by an authorized agent or by communication with the regional cellular network 16.
  • the 113 listing the non-primary mobile stations most recently granted automatic registration privileges is advantageously maintained in order of most recent registration to the cordless cellular base station 12.
  • the last non-primary mobile station on the list i.e., the mobile station least recently granted automatic registration
  • a new mobile station is granted automatic registration privileges and is placed at the top of the second part 114 or non-primary registration list.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 may also advantageously provide an LCD display of the second part
  • the user depresses a function key on the cordless cellular base station to display the second part 114 of the list 113 listing the non-primary mobile stations.
  • the user scrolls through the list of displayed mobile station identification numbers to select a number that he would like to delete.
  • the user then depresses a function key labeled delete on the cordless cellular base station 10 or in an alternative embodiment can enter a series of keys such as, 335#, on the keypad of the cordless cellular base station 10 to delete the highlighted numbers from the second part 115 of the automatic registration list 113.
  • the cordless cellular base station registration list 113 stores a status record 116 that indicates the state of the mobile station with respect to the cordless cellular base station and a mobile station identification number record 117.
  • a status record 116 that indicates the state of the mobile station with respect to the cordless cellular base station and a mobile station identification number record 117.
  • the dormant state shown by a "D" on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12, which has previously registered with the cordless cellular base station 10, is not currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the standby state which is indicated by a "S" on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12 is currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is not currently on a call, i.e., the mobile station 12 is "standing by” waiting to receive or place a call through the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the active state which is shown by an "A” on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is currently on a call which is being controlled by the cordless cellular base station 10. As indicate above, in the preferred embodiment, up to two mobile stations 12 may be listed as active at a time.
  • Figure 9 shows the messages which are passed between the mobile station 12 and the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • Figure 10 shows the process which takes place in the cordless cellular base station 10 to enable the initial registration.
  • the user presses the initial registration button 111 ( Figure 2) on the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the initial registration button 111 Figure 2
  • the depression of the initial registration button is detected and control passes to action block 121.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sets a new registration (new-reg) timer.
  • the new registration timer is set for 30 seconds.
  • the user of the mobile station 12 activates a test registration procedure on the mobile station in step 109.
  • the test registration procedure is activated by the user depressing a test registration function key on the mobile station 12.
  • the user may depress a series of specified keys on the mobile station keypad, such as 878#, to initiate the test registration procedure on the mobile station 12.
  • the initiation of the test registration function causes the mobile station 12 to measure the received signal strength on each channel and to store the measurement. The mobile station then checks the channels which have the strongest receive signal strength to determine if a digital control channel (DCCH) is present.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the mobile station checks the channel with the next highest receive signal strength. If a DCCH is present, the mobile station checks to see if its system ID identifies it as a private system. If it is a private system, the mobile station tries to register with the device by sending out a test registration message (TR) in step 122 of Figure 9.
  • TR test registration message
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the test registration message is received from a mobile station 12. If the test registration message is received, control passes to decision block 124. If the test registration message is not received control passes to decision block 125, where the cordless cellular base station checks to see if the new registration timer (new-reg) has expired. If the timer has not expired, control returns to decision block 123. If the timer has expired, the initial registration attempt is completed.
  • new registration timer new-reg
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 determines if the registration list of Figure 8 is full. If there is still room in the registration list, control passes to action block 126. If the registration list is full, control passes to decision block 127. At decision block 127, the cordless cellular base station 10 determines if the status of one of the non-primary mobile stations 12 in the registration list is indicated as being dormant. If the status of one of the non-primary mobile stations 12 is indicated as being dormant, control passes to action block 128. If none of the non-primary mobile stations 12 is listed as being dormant, control passes to action block 129. At action block 129, a negative test registration response is sent to the mobile station and the initial registration process is abandoned.
  • the non-primary mobile station 12 with the longest inactivity time is removed from the registration list and control passes to action block 126.
  • the non- primary mobile station with the longest inactivity time would be the last non-primary mobile station on the registration list.
  • the mobile station identification number of the requesting mobile station is added to the registration list.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a positive test registration response message (TRR) to the mobile station 12 and control passes to decision block 133.
  • TRR test registration response message
  • test registration response The transmission of the positive or negative test registration response from the cordless cellular base station to the mobile station is shown in step 131 of Figure 9. If a negative test registration response, or no test registration response is received at the mobile station, the mobile station will check the channel with the next highest receive signal strength and repeat the procedure indicated above to try to determine if it is a private system, and if so, to try to register with the device by sending out a test registration message (TR).
  • TR test registration message
  • the mobile station 12 Upon receiving the positive test registration response, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, the mobile station 12 will display a set of alpha characters transmitted by the cordless cellular base station 10 in the test registration message.
  • the alpha characters which are displayed form the word "cordless", at which time the mobile station may decide to accept or reject the cordless registration with the cordless cellular base station. If the user wishes to accept the registration, he depresses a specified series of keys on the keypad, such as 9#. If the user accepts the registration, the mobile station sends a registration message (R) in step 132 of Figure 9 to the cordless cellular base station. If the user wishes to reject the registration, the user depresses another specified series of keys on the keypad, such as 6# or in another embodiment does not depress any keys. If the registration is rejected, no message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • R registration message
  • the cordless cellular base 10 checks to see if a registration message has been received from the mobile station. If a registration message (R) is received, control passes to action block 134. If a registration message (R) was not received control passes to decision block 135 where the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the new_reg timer has expired. If the new_reg timer has not expired, control returns to decision block 133 where the cordless cellular base station will continue to check for the receipt of the registration message (R) from the mobile station. If the new_reg timer has expired without the cordless cellular base station 10 receiving a response from the mobile station 12, control passes to action block 136 where the initial registration attempt is canceled.
  • the new_reg timer is stopped and control passes to action block 137.
  • the cordless cellular base station sends a registration accept message (RA) to the mobile station as is shown in step 138 of Figure 9 and control passes to action block 139.
  • RA registration accept message
  • the status of the mobile station 12 is updated as being in standby mode and the initial registration procedure is completed.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 proceeds with the network update attempt procedure as described in association with Figure 13 below.
  • the mobile station 12 After the mobile station 12 has completed the initial registration with the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 will automatically register with the cordless cellular base station 10 without the need to go through the initial registration procedure. Thus, when a mobile station 12 comes within range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges and the mobile station 12 is not currently handling a call, in accordance with the preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 automatically switches from regional cellular service mode to cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention. The automatic registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10 is discussed in more detail below. Automatic Registration of a Mobile Station with a Cordless Cellular Base Station
  • the mobile station 12 only attempts to locate a cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 is not currently handling a call.
  • a mobile station 12 that is not currently handling a call comes into the range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges, the mobile station 12 preferably automatically deregisters from the cellular network and registers with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 advantageously is able to communicate with up to two mobile stations 12 at one time.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 displays an indication of whether its digital control channel (DCCH) is supporting one or more mobile stations 12.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 displays the mobile identification number of each mobile station 12 that the cordless cellular base station's digital control channel (DCCH) is currently supporting.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 remains ready to receive registrations and other legitimate requests from the mobile stations 12 at any time.
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • the range in which automatic registration with the cordless cellular base station 10 is achievable is dictated by the strength of the transmission signal from the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is capable of transmitting an approximately 6.3 W signal. This translates into an automatic registration range for the cordless cellular base station 10 of approximately 500-1,000 feet.
  • the variation in the registration range is due to the values broadcast on the DCCH of the cordless cellular base station, variations in weather conditions, surrounding EMI interference, and sizes and layouts of the buildings in which the cordless cellular base station 10 may be located.
  • the mobile station 12 searches for the presence of the cordless cellular base station 10 after each selection of a new control channel. Once a new channel is selected, at decision block 140 the cordless cellular base station checks to see if a new digital control channel is selected. If at decision block 140, a new digital control channel is acquired, control passes to action block 142. If at decision block 140, a new digital control channel is not acquired, control passes to decision block 141. If at decision block 141 a new analog control channel is acquired, control passes to action block 142. If at action block 141 a new analog control channel is not acquired, control retums to decision block 140.
  • the current extended Public Service Profile of the mobile station 12 is compared to all the stored extended Public Service Profiles in the table 78 ( Figure 6) in the mobile station for each of cordless cellular base stations 10 that are stored.
  • the extended public service profile preferably contains the CC, SID, ACCH channel number and DCC for the control channel as described above.
  • the extended Public Service Profile preferably contains the CC, SID, DCCH channel number, and DVCC as described above. If at decision block 144 there is an extended PSP match, control passes to action block 146. If at decision block 144, there is no extended PSP match, control passes to action block 148.
  • the mobile station 12 is within the vicinity of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered.
  • the mobile station 12 is provided with a list of frequencies by the cellular network 16 called a neighbor list (NL).
  • the neighbor list is a list of frequencies that the neighboring cells operate on and assists the mobile station in selecting nearby cells for control when the signal strength of the current cell is no longer optimal.
  • the mobile station scans the channels on the neighbor list to determine if a control channel which is stronger than its current control channel can be located on the channels of the neighboring cells.
  • the mobile station 12 advantageously adds the stored primary and alternate cordless cellular base station frequencies that the digital control channel (DCCH) of the cordless cellular base station 10 was detected on, i.e., fg, f j , f 2 , f3, for each row in the table 78 ( Figure 6) on which an extended PSP match was found, to the Neighbor List (NL) forming an extended neighbor list (ENL).
  • DCCH digital control channel
  • NL Neighbor List
  • ENL extended neighbor list
  • a private system identifier such as the RSID of the cordless cellular base station
  • the mobile station 12 synchronizes with that control channel and checks to see if this is an identifier that the mobile station recognizes.
  • the mobile station compares the identifier that is obtained for the control channel with the extended RSID for the cordless cellular base station that it is scanning for.
  • an extended RSID is preferably a country code (CC), a System Operator Code (SOC), and a 16-bit Residential System ID (RSID) for the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • Control passes to action block 156 where the mobile station attempts to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 using the CCBS registration procedure described below in association with Figure 12. If registration succeeds, the mobile station camps on the cordless cellular base station's Digital Control Channel (DCCH). Automatic Registration of a Cordless Cellular Base Station (CCBS)
  • DCCH Digital Control Channel
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the mobile station identification number (MIN) of the mobile station 12 matches a MIN stored in the automatic registration list in the cordless cellular base station 10. If the MIN of the mobile station matches one of the stored MINs, control passes to action block 160. If the MIN of the mobile station 12 does not match one of the stored MINs, control passes to action block 162. At action block 162, the automatic registration attempt is rejected and control passes to action block 164 where the automatic CCBS registration procedure is terminated.
  • MIN mobile station identification number
  • the automatic registration attempt of the mobile station 12 is accepted.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 checks the status of the mobile station in the registration list of Figure 8. If the mobile station 12 is listed as dormant, i.e., not in active or standby modes, control passes to action block 172. If the mobile station 12 is not listed as dormant, control passes to action block 168.
  • the automatic CCBS registration procedure is considered to be completed and control passes to action block 170 where the automatic CCBS registration procedure is terminated.
  • the status of the mobile station 12 is updated as being in standby mode.
  • the automatic CCBS registration procedure is considered to be completed and control passes to action block 176.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 proceeds with the network update attempt procedure as described in association with Figure 13 below. Network Update Attempt
  • Figure 13 illustrates the network update attempt procedure that the cordless cellular base station uses to contact the cellular network to inform it of a recent mobile station registration.
  • decision block 190 the state of the landline 14 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 is checked to determine if the network call forwarding procedure can be initialized. If at decision block 190, the state of the landline 14 is idle, control passes to action block 192, where the Network Call Forwarding Procedure as described in association with Figures 14a and 14b is initiated. If at decision block 190, the state of the landline 14 is not idle, control passes to decision block 194. At decision block 194, the state of the landline is checked to determine if it is busy. If the landline 14 is busy, control passes to decision block 195.
  • decision block 196 the state of the land line is checked to determine if the landline is ringing. If the land line is not ringing, control passes to action block 195. If the land line is ringing, control passes to decision block 198.
  • decision block 198 the state of the voice channels for the first and second mobile stations of the cordless cellular base station are checked to see if there is room to add the mobile station onto the ringing call. If both channels are busy, for example, an intercom call between two mobile stations is in progress, control passes to action block 195. If both channels are not busy, control passes to action block 200.
  • the newly added mobile station is paged, in a manner known to those of skill in the art, and can be added on to the present ringing call if the user presses the send key on the mobile station 12. Whether the mobile responds or not, control passes to action block 195.
  • the Network Call Forwarding Procedure is queued until the cordless cellular base station and the landline are both free and are able to initiate the network call forwarding procedure.
  • the network call forwarding procedure is described below in association with Figures 14a and 14b.
  • the mobile station 12 After the mobile station 12 is registered and referring back to Figure 6, for a new non-primary cordless cellular base station, for a cordless cellular base station that was not previously on the list, the mobile station 12 places the data for this cordless cellular base station 10 in the most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station row 84, just below the row for the primary cordless cellular base station 82. The data for the previous most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station is moved to the next most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station row 86. The row for the least recently used non-primary cordless cellular base station, i.e., the previous next most recent cordless cellular base station row, may be lost.
  • the mobile station 12 places the data regarding the cellular network that it just deregistered from into the table 78. If the cordless cellular base station was already included on the list, the new information simply replaces the information in the old row.
  • the mobile station 12 places the current Country Code in the CC cell, the current System Operator Code in the SOC cell, and the current System Identifier in the SID cell the most recent row as collected from the cordless cellular base station.
  • the public service profile for the mobile station is inferred from the broadcast neighbor list that is received from the cordless cellular base station 10 as described above.
  • the mobile station 12 functions as a cordless telephone mobile station, referred to as operating in the cordless telephone landline service mode.
  • the mobile station provides basic and enhanced telephone services over the landline connected to the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the mobile station supports the enhanced telephone services that are provided by the land network services when it operates in cordless mode, such as call waiting, three-way calling, party line service (i.e., enabling multiple landline numbers to access a single landline), and distinctive ringing services (i.e., different ringing patterns based on the incoming calling number).
  • Network Call Forwarding i.e., Network Call Forwarding
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 After a successful registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10, in a preferred embodiment the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a call forwarding update message to the cellular network 16 requesting that the cellular network 16 route all calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the CCBS VLR informs the cordless cellular base station during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities the CCBS VLR would like to be informed.
  • some of the types of registrations/deregistrations that the CCBS VLR may want to be informed of include: power down registration, power up registration, location area, forced registration, periodic registration, deregistration, new system registration, ACC to DCCH, or TMSI timeout.
  • the location update or call forwarding procedure as illustrated in Figure 14a is executed.
  • the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 dials the stored remote network update number via the PSTN 15 (the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 tries the Remote Network Update Number 1 first and if it is busy it tries the Remote Network Update Number 2) in a network contact calling step 202 (Network Contact Update Call) to contact the cellular network (CN) 16.
  • the cellular network 16 upon answering the call sets up a modem link in step 206.
  • an authentication step (AUTH) 208 the cordless cellular base station 10 starts an authorization timer and sends an authentication message to the cellular network 16 which includes the mobile system identification number to be updated, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count.
  • the cordless cellular base station authorization count maintains a running count of the number of updates the cordless cellular base station 10 has made over this landline number as a fraud prevention mechanism.
  • the cellular network 16 compares the call number ID (CNI) from the PSTN 15 for the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 which made the call with the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 stored in a data base on the cellular network 16 and verifies that the mobile system identification number to be updated, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count provided by the cordless cellular base station 10 match the stored values in the cellular network 16.
  • CNI call number ID
  • a return result message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 210 and the cordless cellular base station authorization count is updated. Further, the cellular network sets a message receive timer to see if the cordless cellular base station 10 is going to send it a message in a specified time period. If the authentication message can not be validated, i.e., if any of the above-referenced values do not match, the cellular network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the authentication timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt a new connection with the cellular network 16 after a specified period of time has elapsed.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 After receiving the return result message, the cordless cellular base station 10 stops the authentication timer, starts a location update timer and sends a location update message to the cellular network 16 in step 212 via a modem link.
  • the location update message comprises the mobile station identification number (MIN) of the registered mobile station 12 for which the calls are to be forwarded and the landline number to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected.
  • the cellular network 16 receives the location update information from the cordless cellular base station 10, verifies that it agrees with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, and stops the message receive timer.
  • the cellular network 16 sends an error message to the cordless cellular base station 10 and resets the message receive timer. If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 resends the return result message, resets the message receive timer one more time, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
  • the cellular network 16 updates the information stored in the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) regarding the mobile station location and sends a return result message in step 214 to the cordless cellular base station 10 over the modem link to verify the receipt of the information.
  • CCBS VLR cordless cellular base station visitor location register
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the location update timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt to resend the location update message after a specified period of time has passed. Once the return result message has been received by the cordless cellular base station 10, the location update timer is stopped. The cellular network 16 ends the call forwarding update procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 220.
  • Figure 14b illustrates an alternate embodiment of the call forwarding procedure, which is the same as the procedure in Figure 14a from steps 202-212.
  • the cellular network checks to see if it needs to send an updated authorization message to the cordless cellular base station 10. If the cellular network needs to send an authorization message, instead of sending the return result message 214 as in Figure 14a, the cellular network 16 sends the cordless cellular base station authorization message which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a list of authorized or operational parameters including operational frequencies, which is the same as the initial authorization message described above, and sets a retum result timer.
  • cordless cellular base station 10 resends the location update message, resets the timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message have been received from the cellular network 16, the cordless cellular base station 10, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If an invalid authorization message is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization error message to the cellular network, resets the timer and may wait for the receipt of a new authorization message.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 updates its operational parameters as received in the message and stops the authorization timer.
  • the cellular network 16 is able to prevent the cordless cellular base station 10 from operating by removing all of its operational frequencies in the cordless cellular base station authorization message. This is a simple way to cancel the service of an unauthorized user.
  • the network 16 may update the operational parameters, of the cordless cellular base station 10 with the cordless cellular base station authorization message. For example, the cellular network 16 may update the list of operational frequencies of the cordless cellular base station 10, if it is determined that an insufficient number of ciear frequencies have been provided to the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of the authorization message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 218. If the cellular network does not receive the retum result message before its return result timer expires, the cellular network 1 resends the CCBS authorization message, resets the return result timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts a retum result has not been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding update, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the return result message is received, the cellular network 16 ends the call forwarding update procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 220.
  • the cellular network 16 routes ali calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cellular network 16 can be broken down into the following components: the mobile switching complex (MSC) 222, the home location register (HLR) 224, a traditional visitor location register (VLR) 226 and the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) 228.
  • the mobile switching complex 222, home location register 224 and visitor location register 226 are generally the same as the components that generally exist currently in a standard cellular network, as known to those of skill in the art.
  • the present invention adds the CCBS VLR 228 which is a data base that stores the location, i.e., landline number, of the mobile stations which are being controlled by the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 calls the cellular network 16 in step 230, it is communicating with the CCBS VLR 228 to provide the information regarding the location update and location update cancel requests.
  • the CCBS VLR 228 sends a REG NOT INVOKE message in step 232 to the HLR 224 associated with the mobile station to inform the HLR 224 that the information for routing calls for that particular mobile station identification number is available from the sending CCBS VLR 228.
  • the HLR 224 responds in step 234 with a REG NOT RETURN RESULT message indicating that it has received and accepted the location update message.
  • the call is sent to the MSC 222 in step 236.
  • the originating MSC 222 sends a LOCATION REQUEST message to the mobile station's HLR 224 in step 238.
  • the HLR 224 recognizes that the location of the mobile station is being controlled by the CCBS VLR 228 which contacted it earlier.
  • the HLR 224 constructs a ROUTING REQUEST message and sends it to the CCBS VLR 228 that provided the earlier REG NOT INVOKE message providing an update of the mobile's location.
  • THE CCBS VLR 228 locates a TLDN for the landline that the cordless cellular base station is connected to and returns this information to the HLR 224 in a ROUTING REQUEST RESPONSE message in step 242.
  • the HLR 224 adds the MIN and the ESN of the mobile station to the routing information and retums a LOCATION RESPONSE message to the originating MSC 222 in step 244.
  • the MSC 222 places the call over the PSTN 15 and the call is delivered to the landline number for the cordless cellular base station 10 that is routing the calls for the mobile station.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 pages the mobile stations 12 listed in standby mode as indicated below and the PSTN 15 rings the extension phones attached to the landline number in step 246, thus completing the call forwarding process. If there are two or fewer mobile stations listed in standby mode, the cordless cellular base station pages the mobile station in a conventional manner as a regional cell would page a mobile station, i.e., providing the digital control channel information and the calling number information to enable the mobile station to answer the call if the send button is depressed. If more than two mobile stations are listed in standby mode, all of the mobile stations receive an alert message which enables the phones to ring, but does not include the digital traffic channel information to answer the call.
  • the cordless cellular base station listens for the first mobile station to depress the send button.
  • the cordless cellular base station will send that mobile station the digital traffic channel information which will enable the mobile station to answer the call.
  • the primary user if the primary user is listed as being in standby mode, the primary user will always be paged with the digital control channel information to answer the call and the remaining mobiles listed as being in standby will be sent the alert message and will ring. If the primary user presses the send button first, the call will be answered immediately. If one of the other mobile stations presses the send button first, the primary user will be unable to answer the call immediately.
  • the cordless cellular base station will send the first responding mobile station the digital traffic channel information. Upon receiving the digital traffic channel information, the other mobile station will be able to answer the call.
  • cordless cellular base station 10 In order to enable the cellular network 16 to periodically change the operational parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10, cordless cellular base station 10 preferably includes a preset timer which counts down the amount of time since the cordless cellular base station 10 last contacted the cellular network 16. When the timer expires, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically contacts the cellular network 16. In the preferred embodiment, the timer is set for thirty days; thus if the cordless cellular base station 10 has not contacted the cellular network 16 within thirty days, for example, to request a location update for a registered mobile station, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically contacts the cellular network 16. In response the cellular network determines if it is necessary to send the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message.
  • the cellular network sends the message to the cordless cellular base station. If a new authorization message is not required, the cellular network sends a return result message to the cordless cellular base station.
  • the timer in the cordless cellular base station is reset for thirty days. This feature is advantageous for several reasons. First, this enables the cellular network 16 to regularly update the operational parameters in the cordless cellular base station 10 to accommodate changes in the service in the area around the cordless cellular base station 10 and to update the cordless cellular base station on any changed features of the cellular network 16. For example, the cellular network 16 may temporarily alter the telephone number that the cordless cellular base station 10 calls to access the location update/call forwarding feature.
  • this feature is useful in preventing fraudulent usage of a cordless cellular base station 10. For example, if the owner did not pay the bill for the service and also stopped using the cordless cellular base station 10 or kept the mobile stations exclusively at home but continued the use of the CCBS, it would be difficult for the cellular network 16 to remotely cancel the operation of the cordless cellular base station 10, because the cordless cellular base station 10 may not ever contact the cellular network 16. With the automatic contact feature, the cellular network 16 would automatically contact the cordless cellular base station 10 every thirty days. The network 16 could then send a new authorization message removing all of the operating frequencies from the cordless cellular base station which belonged to the non-paying customer, thus making the cordless cellular base station 10 inoperable. Call Initiation and Reception
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 when a call is initiated by a registered mobile station 12 that is in the standby mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the air interface transaction required to establish a cellular originated call and connect it to the landline service. Before connecting the call to the land line 14, however, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably checks first to see if the phone number matches the MIN for one of the other mobile stations 12 which is listed in standby mode in the registration table 113 ( Figure 8) on the cordless cellular base station 10. If the phone number matches a MIN for the one of the mobile stations 12 listed in standby mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 pages that mobile station 12 and initiates an intercom conversation between the two mobile stations. The intercom feature is described in more detail below. The intercom conversation does not make the landline 14 busy, so the wireline extensions connected to the landline 14 can initiate and receive calls over the landline 14 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 does not have the capability of ringing the phones associated with the landline 14 as the ring signal for those phones are provided by the PSTN 15. Further, while it might be possible to set the cordless cellular base station 10 up so it could call the other land line extensions (e.g., by requiring that the CCBS be connected to two separate PSTN Iines), this would add some significant expense for very little additional value. Thus, this is not a preferred embodiment.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 bridges the call such that each mobile station 12 acts as an "extension." In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 can bridge up to two mobile stations 12 on a single call. If a third mobile station or more attempts to add to the call, the additional mobile stations 12 are denied access to the cordless cellular base station 10 and are not added to the call, thus remaining in standby mode. If at any time a call being handled by the cordless cellular base station 10 is in progress and only one mobile station is listed as being active, a second mobile station 12 in standby mode can be added to the call by pressing the send button on the second mobile station 12.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 When there are two mobile stations 12 bridged by the cordless cellular base station CCBS 10 to a call on the PSTN 15, the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to match the functionality and performance of regular extension telephone operation. Each mobile station 12 is able to receive the voice data from both the other mobile station and the signals from the PSTN 15.
  • the preferred embodiment utilizes a system in which the sum of the mobile station 12 and the PSTN 15 voice signals are encoded.
  • the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 utilizes a CODEC 250 which contains a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 as known to those of skill in the art.
  • VSE VSELP speech encoder
  • VSD VSELP speech decoder
  • Figure 16 shows that two CODECs are used for the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • only a single CODEC 250 is used and the transmission to/from each mobile station 12 is shifted in time, thus enabling a single CODEC in the cordless cellular base station 10 to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations 12.
  • the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are preferably sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communication protocol.
  • the signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal.
  • the voice signal from the first mobile station is summed at summer 256 with the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the 2-wire to 4-wire hybrid device (H).
  • the summed signal is then encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the second mobile station (MS2) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol.
  • the second mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the second mobile station is able to listen to the voices of both parties on the PSTN 15 and on the first mobile station.
  • the audio communication from the second mobile station (MS2) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communicatio ⁇ protocol.
  • the signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal.
  • the voice signal from the second mobile station is summed at summer 258 with the voice signal received from the PSTN 15 and encoded by the hybrid device (H).
  • the summed signal is then encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the first mobile station (MS1) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol.
  • the first mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 compares a voice signal from one mobile station with the voice signal from the PSTN and whichever is louder is sent to the other mobile station. Similar to the embodiment of Figure 16, the cordless cellular base station utilizes a CODEC 250 which contains a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 as known to those of skill in the art.
  • VSE VSELP speech encoder
  • VSD VSELP speech decoder
  • Figure 17 shows that two CODECS are used by the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • a single CODEC 250 is used and the transmission to/from each mobile station is shifted in time, thus enabling a single CODEC in the cordless cellular base station to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations.
  • the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station (MS1) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol.
  • the signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal.
  • VSE VSELP speech encoder
  • VSD VSELP speech decoder
  • the voice signal from the first mobile station is compared to the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the hybrid device (H) by a voice level comparator (VLC) 260.
  • the voice level comparator 260 selects which of the two signals is louder and controls the operation of a switch 262 to enable the louder of the two signal to pass to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 250 for the second mobile station (MS2) which is encoded into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the second mobile station (MS2) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol.
  • the second mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the second mobile station is only able to listen to the voice of the louder of the parties on the PSTN 15 and on the first mobile station.
  • the communications or voice signals from a second mobile station are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol.
  • the signal is received by the cordless cellular base station and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal.
  • the voice signal from the second mobile station is compared to the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the hybrid device (H) by a voice level comparator (VLC) 260.
  • the voice level comparator 260 selects which of the two signals is louder and controls the operation of a switch 262 to enable the louder of the two signal to pass to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 for the first mobile station (MS1) which is encoded into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the first mobile station (MS1) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol.
  • the first mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the first mobile station is only able to listen to the voice of the louder of the parties on the PSTN 15 and on the second mobile station.
  • the voice signal from the second mobile station is summed with the voice signal received from the first mobile station at summer 264 and are encoded by the hybrid device (H) for delivery to the user on the PSTN 15.
  • the hybrid device (H) for delivery to the user on the PSTN 15.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 listens for whichever of the two mobile stations is sending the louder signal and accepts the voice communication from that mobile station.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 utilizes a CODEC 250 which is made up of a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 250 as known to those of skill in the art.
  • VSE VSELP speech encoder
  • VSD VSELP speech decoder
  • a single CODEC 250 is used to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations.
  • the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station (MS1) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communication protocol.
  • the communication or analog voice signals from a second mobile station are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol.
  • a detector 266 determines which of the two signals is the louder and passes that signal to the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 which is decoded to a voice signal and is sent to the hybrid for the listener on the PSTN 15 to hear.
  • the signal from the PSTN 15 is sent through the hybrid and to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 where the signal is digitally compressed.
  • the signal from the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 is sent to both the first and second mobile station (MS2) using the IS- 136 cellular communications protocol.
  • VSE VSELP encoder
  • MS1/MS2 the mobile stations
  • VSD VSELP speech decoder
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 has an intercom capability to connect the standby registered mobile stations 12 with each other through the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • Figure 16 as an example of the cordless cellular base station 10 circuitry, in the intercom feature, two mobile stations 12 are connected to the cordless cellular base station 10, and there is no speech connection to the PSTN 15.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 relays the encoded speech data stream from each mobile station 12 to the other without decoding in the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • Each mobile station 12 decodes the received encoded speech data from the other mobile station 12 for the user to hear.
  • the VSELP processing in the cordless cellular base station described in association with Figures 16-18 is bypassed when the intercom feature is used.
  • the mobile station 12 sends a Power-Down deregistration (which is an IS- 136 message) to the cordless cellular base station 10 when the power to the mobile station 12 is turned off.
  • the mobile station 12 deregisters from the cordless cellular base station 10 when the cordless cellular base station's signal becomes too weak, i.e., when the mobile station 12 moves out of the range of the cordless cellular base station 10 or when the user presses a soft key sequence on the keypad of the mobile station 12 and forces a deregistration.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 updates the status of the mobile station 12 in the registration list ( Figure 8) from an "active" or "standby" status to a dormant status.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably informs the cellular network 16, so that the routing of calls for the mobile station identification number (MIN) to the landline number is disabled.
  • the mobile station 12 may then register with the regional cellular network 16, using measurements of the received signal strengths for the neighboring cells, as is known to those of skill in the art.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 may request that the mobile station 12 register periodically.
  • the mobile station 12 registration period is approximately every five minutes; that is, the mobile station 12 needs to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 at least every five minutes to maintain a connection with the cordless cellular base station 10. If the registration of the mobile station 12 is not detected during the five minute registration period, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically deregisters the mobile station 12, utilizing the deregistration procedure described above.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the CCBS VLR to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is informed during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities that the CCBS VLR wants to be informed.
  • types of deregistration events for which the network may want to be contacted are: when the mobile station is turned off, i.e., a power down deregistration, when a manual cancellation of the cordless service mode occurs, i.e., forced deregistration, etc.
  • the cordless cellular base station sends a network cancellation message to the CCBS VLR. If the cordless cellular base station 10 is unable to complete the network cancellation of the call forwarding feature on the first attempt, a second attempt is made. If the second attempt is also unsuccessful, no additional actions are required of the cordless cellular base station 10. The calls for the mobile station 12, however, will continue to be forwarded to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 until the mobile station 12 registers with the cellular network 16 which will automatically update its location and will therefore cancel the old call forwarding message.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the CCBS VLR informs the cordless cellular base station during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities that the CCBS VLR would like to be informed.
  • the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 calls the remote network update number (the CCBS 10 tries the Remote Network Update Number 1 first and if it is busy it tries the Remote Network Update Number 2) in a network contact calling step (Network Contact Call) 268 via the public switched telephone network 15, to contact the cellular network (CN) 16.
  • the cellular network 16 upon answering the call sets up a modem link in step 272.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 starts an authorization timer and sends an authentication message to the cellular network 16 which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count for the landline number. Further, the authentication message may include the mobile system identification number for which the call forwarding message is to be canceled. If a mobile system identification number is not included, the cellular network 16 will cancel the call forwarding for all of the mobile stations currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station authorization count maintains a running score of the number of updates the cordless cellular base station 10 has made over this landline number as a fraud prevention mechanism.
  • the cellular network 16 compares the call number ID (CNI) from the PSTN for the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 which made the call with the landline number for the cordless cellular base station 10 stored in a data base on the cellular network 16. In addition, the cellular network 16 verifies that the mobile system identification number to be updated, if included, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count provided by the cordless cellular base station 10 match the stored values in the cellular network 16. Once the authentication message is processed and validated, a return result message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 276 and the cordless cellular base station 10 authorization count is updated.
  • CNI call number ID
  • the cellular network 16 sets a message receive timer to see if the cordless cellular base station 10 is going to send it a message. If the authentication message cannot be validated, i.e., if any of the above-referenced values do not match, the cellular network breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the retum result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the authentication timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station will process the error and may attempt a new connection with the cellular network 16 after a specified period of time has elapsed.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 After receiving the return result message, the cordless cellular base station 10 stops the authentication timer, starts a message receive timer and sends a network cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls to the cordless cellular base station in step 278 via a modem link.
  • the network cancellation message comprises at least the landline number to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected.
  • the network cancellation message may include the mobile system identification number for the mobile station to which the call forwarding cancellation is to apply. If the mobile station identification number is not provided, the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding feature for all mobile stations which are serviced by the cordless cellular base station 10 that is connected to the designated landline.
  • the cellular network 16 receives the network cancellation message from the cordless cellular base station 10, verifies that it agrees with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, and stops the message receive timer. If parameters received from the cordless cellular base station 10 do not agree with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, the cellular network 16 sends an error message to the cordless cellular base station 10 and resets the message receive timer. If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 resends the return result message, resets the message receive timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
  • the cellular network 16 updates the information stored in the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) regarding the location of the mobile station and sends a return result message in step 280 to the cordless cellular base station 10 over the modem link to verify the receipt of the information.
  • CCBS VLR cordless cellular base station visitor location register
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the message receive timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt to resend the location update message after a specified period of time has passed. Once the return result message has been received by the cordless cellular base station 10, the message receive timer is stopped. The cellular network ends the call forwarding cancellation procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 286.
  • Figure 19b illustrates an alternate embodiment of the network forwarding cancellation procedure, which is the same as the procedure in Figure 19a from steps 268-278.
  • the cellular network checks to see if it needs to send an updated authorization message to the cordless cellular base station 10. If the cellular network needs to send an authorization message, instead of sending the return result message as in Figure 19a, the cellular network 16 sends the cordless cellular base station authorization message in step 282, which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a list of operational frequencies, which is the same as the initial authorization message described above, and sets a return result timer.
  • cordless cellular base station 10 If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cellular network 16, cordless cellular base station 10 resends the network cancellation message, resets the timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the network 16, the cordless cellular base station 10 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If an invalid authorization message is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization error message to the cellular network 16, resets the timer, and may wait for the receipt of a new authorization message.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 updates its operational parameters as received in the message and stops the authorization timer.
  • the cellular network 16 is able to revoke the cordless cellular base station's operational authority or update the operational parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10 with the cordless cellular base station authorization message.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 284. If the cellular network 16 does not receive the return result message before its retum result timer expires, the cellular network 16 the CCBS authorization message, resets the return result timer, and waits for a response.
  • the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding update, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the retum result message is received, the cellular network ends the call forwarding cancellation procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 286. After the call forwarding cancellation process is complete, the cellular network 16 no longer routes all calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the procedure for how the cancellation is updated within the cellular network is similar to the process described in association with Figures 19a and 19b above for the initiation of the call forwarding except that the CCBS VLR 228 revokes its location change request from the HLR 224, and it lets the HLR 224 handle all of the requests for the mobile station 12.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is designed to operate in the residential home or office environment. This environment can be potentially very noisy because potentially no dedicated frequency spectrum is allocated for the cordless cellular base station operation coupled with the fact that the CCBS frequency usage is not explicitly coordinated with the regional cellular network's frequency use.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 has to co-exist in the same cellular band used by the regional cellular network 16 and views the regional cellular network 16 as a source of background interference.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 attempts to avoid the potential interference by the cellular network 16 by choosing frequencies which, as far as the cordless cellular base station 10 can determine, are not being used by nearby regional cells 18 or by other nearby cordless cellular base stations 10.
  • the regional cellular network 16 Since the regional cellular network 16 is unaware of the operating frequency of the cordless cellular base station 10, it is likely that this system will occasionally assign voice or control traffic to a channel on which the cordless cellular base station is operating. Further, it is possible that another cordless cellular base station 10 located close by could be using the same frequency. When such a "collision" between the cordless cellular base station 10 and a regional cellular network 16 happens, priority is given to the regional cellular base station 18.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 implements a channel selection algorithm using software instructions, which are stored in the memory of the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the processor of the cordless cellular base station preferably operates on the instructions to implement the channel selection algorithm.
  • the channel selection algorithm of the preferred embodiment scans the downlink frequencies in the cellular band and determines the best and the next-best downlink cellular frequencies for cordless operation at all times, as described in more detail below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 periodically measures received signal strength (RSS) for each of the authorized downlink frequencies of the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • RSS received signal strength
  • the cordless cellular base station takes RSS measurements on the current uplink operational frequency.
  • WER uplink word error rate
  • the above measurements may also be made by the mobile stations using the IS-136 MAHO measurement capabilities known to those of skill in the art.
  • the mobile station 12 then relays its measurements to the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 translates the RSS and WER measurements into a score increment or decrement value based upon a stored score increment table. After each measurement, the current score increment/decrement value is added to the previous score value.
  • the score for a frequency is a measure of the amount of noise plus interference at a given frequency, thus the score itself is a measure of the potential of interference if this channel were selected rather than the actual interference occurring on the channel.
  • the interference score represents the potential interference that would be encountered on that frequency, with a higher score representing more interference, and a lower score representing lower interference. In the absence of interference, the score value will gradually decay towards zero as more measurements are made. In addition, when frequencies are found to have significant interference, they are quickly removed from consideration and are only reconsidered after some significant quiet period in accordance with the scoring mechanism and thresholds described in more detail herein.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 uses the interference score measurements in making the choice of an operating frequency. By selecting a frequency from those with the lowest interference scores, and by using appropriate channel abandonment thresholds described below, the cordless cellular base station 10 attempts to avoid transmitting on any frequency which is already in use by the public cellular network 16 or by other cordless cellular base stations 10 within range. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station selects for its initial operational frequency the frequency with the lowest interference score. The cordless cellular base station 10 selects for its backup frequencies a specified number of downlink frequencies whose scores are below a high threshold value (Ht).
  • Ht high threshold value
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically switches its operational frequency to the first backup frequency as described in more detail below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 also removes backup frequencies from the back-up frequency list if the interference score rises above the high threshold (Ht).
  • the cordless cellular base station needs to locate a specified number of downlink frequencies (referred to herein as M) having score values below the high threshold value (Ht).
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 If a sufficient number of frequencies are not available, i.e., less than M frequencies are available, the cordless cellular base station 10 notifies the cellular network 16 of the problem.
  • the cellular network will provide the cordless cellular base station with a list of altemative frequencies for operation.
  • the cellular network 16 will temporarily disable the cordless cellular base station 10 for a specified period of time and then will enable its operation on the same frequencies which are hopefully free from interference at this later time. The remainder of the interference measurement procedure is described in more detail below. Interference Measurement
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 has a variety of different modes of operation that affect the number and type of interference measurements that are performed.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 In the basic operational mode when the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for use and none of its registered mobile stations 12 are processing a call, i.e., are in an active state, the cordless cellular base station 10 performs an interference measurement during time slot 4 (40) of the cordless cellular base station transmit time frame 36.
  • time slot 4 40
  • the receiver will be silent on timeslot 5 (41) of the receive time frame 35 because the mobile station will not be sending voice information for the digital traffic channel of the second mobile station (DT2).
  • the transmitter does not transmit any information on timeslot 4 (40) of the transmit time frame 36, the cordless cellular base station 10 will not be generating any of its own interference and thus can make an accurate measurement of the interference generated by its environment.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the interference on its own operating frequency, the strength of the interference received on the receiver is measured when no transmission is specifically broadcast to the receiver of the cordless cellular base station, as known to those of skill in the art.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures activity on a downlink frequency other than the operating frequency, the received signal strength (RSS) in dBm is the noise plus interference power (NPIP).
  • RSS received signal strength
  • NPIP noise plus interference power
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 can measure signal strength on the downlink operating frequency, i.e., the frequency used by the cellular base station to communicate with the mobile station 12, during the cordless cellular base station's silent transmission period in Time Slot 4 (40) of the TDMA transmission frame 36. If fewer than two mobile stations 12 are active, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the receive signal strength on the uplink operating frequency, i.e., the frequency used by the cellular base station to communicate with the mobile station 12, during unused time slots as described in more detail below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 When the cordless cellular base station 10 measures signal strength and word error rate (WER) in a digital traffic channel (DTC) time slot on the uplink operating frequency, the RSS includes both the desired signal and the noise and interference. For these measurements, the cordless cellular base station 10 first converts the measured word error rate (WER) into an equivalent signal to noise-plus-interfere ⁇ ce ratio (SNIR), using the conversation factors known to those of skill in the art. Once the SNIR has been determined, the cordless cellular base station 10 estimates the noise-pius-interference signal strength as:
  • RSS is the total received power
  • the measurement result is expressed as a power equivalent (in dBm) of the noise plus interference (NPIP) value.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 has several different modes of operation that affect the number and type of measurements that can be performed. Each of the modes of operation and the types of measurements made in each mode are described in more detail in the subsections below. In addition, all of the modes of operation and the types of measurements which can be performed in each mode are summarized in Table 1 below.
  • DTC one mobile station call-connected optional downlink RSS MAHO, downlink WER on all authorized frequencies, uplink RSS on fg only uplink WER
  • the silent mode encompasses all states in which the cordless cellular base station's transmitter is turned off.
  • the cordless cellular base station's transmitter is turned off for a number of reasons: (1) the cordless cellular base station 10 has not received network authorization to transmit; (2) transmit authorization has been received, but there are an insufficient number of acceptable operating frequencies, i.e., frequencies with interference scores below Ht; (3) the cordless cellular base station 10 has found an insufficient number of initially acceptable operating frequencies when it abandoned its last operating frequency; or (4) transmit authorization has been revoked.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 may for a period of time have an insufficient number of acceptable clear channels so the transmitter is silent. In another case, the cordless cellular base station 10 may have an insufficient number of acceptable channels when it abandoned its last operating frequency and is temporarily silent. Without at least one clear channel, the cordless cellular base station 10 cannot communicate with any of the mobile stations so the cordless cellular base station has no phone related transmission or reception duties. Therefore, the cordless cellular base station can make interference measurements on all of the time slots 1-6. Because additional time slots are available for making interference measurements, the cordless cellular base station is referred to as being in a fast interference measurement mode.
  • the measurement rate is expected to be substantially higher than one measurement per TDMA frame. Further, in this mode the cordless cellular base station only measures the down link frequencies so it can establish a sufficient number of clear channels below the Ht threshold. In a preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station should have M channels with interference scores below Ht before initial operation can begin. Once the cordless cellular base station finds a sufficient number of ciear channels with scores below the Ht threshold, the cordless cellular base station preferably selects the frequency with the lowest interference score to be the downlink operating frequency and starts broadcasting its DCCH on this frequency. At this point, the cordless cellular base station moves into its authorized mode. Cordless Cellular Base Station Measurements in Authorized Mode
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 On receipt of authorization to transmit, the cordless cellular base station 10 first notes the list of allowed frequencies given in the authorization transaction. Interference measurements are restricted to this set of allowed frequencies. Note that this list could include all frequencies in the cellular frequency range.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 When the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for operation (transmitting a DCCH), the cordless cellular base station 10 makes several types of measurements, depending on the operating mode. No Mobile Stations in Active Mode
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 makes downlink RSS measurements for all of the authorized downlink frequencies using the scheme described below and uplink RSS measurements for the current uplink frequency only.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is transmitting its half -rate digital control channel on time slot 1, there are no required transmissions on time slots 2, 3, 5, and 6 besides idle codes because there is no call in progress to send voice information for DTC1 or DTC2.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 will normally be silent during Time Slot 4 and during this silence in time slot 4 of the transmission frame, at a time when neither the transmitter nor the receiver is in use, the cordless cellular base station 10 will make interference measurements, as described below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 nominally makes one downlink interference measurement in time slot 4 per TDMA frame.
  • the downlink frequency to be measured are chosen as follows: (1) in 50% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the current downlink operating frequency; (2) in 25% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the three downlink backup frequencies; (3) in 20% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is below the low threshold (Lt); (4) in 5% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is at or above the low threshold (Lt).
  • the estimated noise plus interference is correlated with all other estimates of noise plus interference on the operating frequency available for this 40 ms TDMA frame. The largest interference estimate is used, and any others are ignored.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
  • the uplink RSS measurements are made as follows. Since no mobile stations are active on receive time slots 2, 3, 5 and 6, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures uplink RSS at least once per frame in one of these time slots. The RSS measurement is used as an estimated noise-plus-interference signal strength on the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with other estimates of the noise plus interference on the operating frequency and the largest interference estimate is determined. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 when one mobile station 12 is active, the cordless cellular base station 10 makes uplink RSS and WER measurements for the current uplink frequency only and the mobile station 12 makes downlink WER measurements and forwards them to the cordless cellular base station.
  • the cordless cellular base station also makes downlink RSS measurements of all of the authorized downlink frequencies using the scheme described below. However, in other embodiments, the cordless cellular base station may not make downlink RSS measurements.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 nominally makes one downlink RSS interference measurement on time slot 4 per TDMA frame.
  • the downlink frequency to be measured is chosen as follows: (1) in 50% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the current downlink operating frequency; (2) in 25% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the three backup downlink frequencies; (3) in 20% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is below Lt; (4) in 5% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is at or above Lt.
  • the estimated noise plus interference is correlated with all other estimates of noise plus interference on the operating frequency available for this 40 ms TDMA frame. The largest interference estimate is used, and any others are ignored.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
  • the CCBS When one mobile station 12 is active, the CCBS establishes the digital traffic channel on receive time slots 3 and 6, i.e., DTC1. However, time slots 2 and 5 are still unused, therefore the cordless cellular base station 10 may attempt to measure uplink RSS at least once per frame in one of these available time slots. Preferably, the uplink RSS measurement is made during the receive time slot 5 as it is most likely not to receive interference from the transmission of the DCCH of the cordless cellular base station. The RSS measurement is used as an estimated noise-plus-interference signal strength on the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with other estimates of the noise plus interference on the operating frequency and the largest interference estimate is determined.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 Besides measuring the RSS uplink information, the cordless cellular base station 10 also measures the uplink WER for the Digital Traffic Channel (DTC) being received from that mobile station 12 at least once, and more preferably twice, per 40 ms TDMA frame.
  • the uplink WER and uplink RSS measurements are combined per the equation described above to achieve an uplink noise plus interference measurement for the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with all other estimates of noise plus interference available for this 40 ms TDMA frame (for example signal quality reports from the mobile) and the largest interference estimate is determined.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
  • the mobile station When one of the cordless cellular base station's mobile stations is in the active mode, the mobile station, in compliance with IS-136, will be making downlink MAHO RSS and WER interference measurements of its own since the CCBS will command it to do so.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 receives these measurements from the mobile station 12 and scores them as discussed below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 updates the mobile's MAHO neighbor list each two to ten seconds.
  • the mobile's MAHO neighbor list is updated every five seconds.
  • the digital control channel DCCH from a base station to a mobile station 12 can send control information using one of two control channel formats, the fast associated control channel (FACCH) and the slow associated control channel (SACCH) formats.
  • the SACCH format uses a concatenated set of 12-bit fields from multiple TDMA bursts to transmit control information during the normal DTC.
  • the FACCH format is used when the control information is longer and cannot wait for the next DTC time slot to send the balance of the message. Since the FACCH message steals voice capacity from the digital traffic channel, it is preferable to wait to send the FACCH message until there is a detectable silence in the conversation on the digital traffic channel so the users will not detect the interruption during which the FACCH message is sent.
  • the neighbor list update is sent using the FACCH, therefore the cordless cellular base station 10 is required to detect voice activity (possibly based on the RO level of the VSELP codec) to determine when a quiet period has occurred during the conversation to send the neighbor list update message for minimum degradation of voice quality.
  • the neighbor list update message is preferably sent at the first opportunity (i.e., when silence in the voice signal from the cordless cellular base station 10 to the mobile is detected) after the MAHO report from the previous list has been received. If there is no opportunity within ten seconds, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends the neighbor list update message regardless.
  • the MAHO neighbor list preferably comprises up to twenty-four downlink frequencies.
  • the twelve downlink frequencies are chosen from the list of authorized downlink frequencies assigned to the cordless cellular base station.
  • the twelve downlink frequencies comprise the three backup frequencies selected by the cordless cellular base station, plus nine from the remaining authorized downlink frequencies for the cordless cellular base station.
  • seven of the nine frequencies are selected among the frequencies whose score is below Lt. If there are fewer than seven such frequencies, the cordless cellular base station 10 includes ail the frequencies whose interference scores are below Lt. The balance of the nine frequencies are selected from among the remaining frequencies, other than the current operating frequency.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 cannot measure signal strength during Time Slot 4 of the CCBS transmit frame. This is because time slot 5 of the CCBS receive frame occurs at the same time as transmit time slot 4, and the cordless cellular base station's receiver is used during the receive frame time slot 5 as part of the second digital traffic channel (DTC2) for the second mobile station 12.
  • DTC2 digital traffic channel
  • the cordless cellular base station can only monitor the uplink WER and RSS for each of the mobile stations.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 must rely on the downlink RSS MAHO measurements and the downlink WER measurements from the two mobile stations 12, which necessarily excludes the measurement of the current operating frequency of each of the mobile stations.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 loses the ability to measure the RSS of interference on the operating frequency, unless the interference is large enough to affect the word error rates (WERs).
  • WERs word error rates
  • both of the mobile stations will be making MAHO downlink RSS and downlink WER interference measurements of their own.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 receives these measurements from either one of the mobile stations 12 and scores the measurements as discussed below.
  • the only measurement that the cordless cellular base station 10 can make itself is the uplink WER and RSS measurements for each of the digital traffic channels (DTC) of the mobile stations 12.
  • the uplink WER measurement is made twice per 40 ms TDMA frame per digital traffic channel (DTC).
  • the uplink WER measurements from the cordless cellular base station 10 is combined with the downlink RSS MAHO measurement and the downlink WER measurement made by one of the mobile stations and used as a measurement of downlink noise plus interference.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below. Score Determination
  • the interference measurements are translated into a score increment or decrement.
  • the interference score for each frequency can preferably range from 0 to 2 2 -1.
  • the CCBS VLR provides the cordless cellular base station 10 with the initial score value for each of the operational frequencies in the authorization message that is sent by the cellular network 16.
  • the initial score value is set to be a default value when the CCBS is manufactured.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 on power-up or reset, initializes the frequency scores to a value equivalent to the high threshold (Ht) + 7500. This makes these frequencies initially unacceptable for use but available if they stay clear for 5 minutes, which is equivalent to 7500 40 ms TDMA frames.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 initializes scores on any frequencies that were not previously allowed to Ht+7500.
  • certain of the new frequencies on the allowed frequency list may be sent with preassigned initial values. The frequencies which are sent with preassigned initial values will override the initial value set at the time of manufacturing or previously provided by the CCBS VLR.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 takes the interference measurement for each frequency which is expressed as a power equivalent (in dBm) of the noise plus interference and translates the measured noise plus interference power level into a score increment or decrement using a staircase function 288 in Figure 20.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 determines between which X values the interference measurement occurs and reads the appropriate decrement or increment value from the Y axis.
  • the X values for a mobile station measurement are different from the X values for the cordless cellular base station measurement.
  • the reason for this difference is that the mobile station 12 will be able to move from inside the home or office environment to outside of the home or office environment and it is believed that it will be subject to a slightly elevated level of interference because of its ability to be located outside.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 on the other hand, is stationary and will remain inside where it is believed that it will be subjected to less interference. To reconcile this difference, less interference detected by the cordless cellular base station 10 is required to make a larger jump in the interference score.
  • a -90 dBm measurement by the cordless cellular base station 10 would result in an interference score at the Y 3 level
  • -90 dBm measurement by the mobile station 12 would result in an interference score at the Y 2 level.
  • Table 2 The preferred X values for Figure 20 are shown in Table 2 below:
  • the value for X 1 for the cordless cellular base station is set at 6 dBm above the receiver's noise floor.
  • the receiver's noise floor is -118 dBm, thus the preferred value for X 1 for the cordless cellular base station is -112 dBm.
  • Y ma ⁇ is the full-scale (saturation) value of the score.
  • Y ma ⁇ is 2 22 -1.
  • the values of Yg and Y 2 are proportional to the interval between successive measurements on the frequency in question. This normalizes the measurements, making the decay rate for a score on a clear frequency independent of the measurement rate. For example, once a particular score reaches
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 adds the increment or decrement value read from the Y axis to the previous interference score for the measured frequency.
  • the increment values of the Y axis were chosen such that interference above the X 3 value will cause a large jump in the interference score and will quickly make this channel undesirable for use as either a backup frequency or an operating frequency.
  • interference between the X 3 value and the X 2 value will cause a medium size jump in the interference score which should make it undesirable for use as an operating frequency, but could make it useable as a backup frequency depending upon how persistent this level of interference is.
  • Interference between the X 2 value and the X ⁇ will not change the present score value, so the channel will remain in its current use level.
  • Interference below the X 1 value will enable the interference score to be decremented, thus making it more desirable for use as a potential backup or operational frequency.
  • the increment and decrement values were chosen such that continual interference measurements on the same frequency causes the score to increase rapidly to quickly alert the cordless cellular base station 10 of the interference.
  • occasional interference which is bursty in nature, i.e., sometimes detected on the channel sometimes not detected on the channel, causes the score to increase more slowly but if persistent it eventually can lead to the channel scoring unacceptably high.
  • a decrement allows the score to slowly decay toward zero.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 stores the scores for each of the operational frequencies in a data base, such as the date base shown in Table 4 below. Table 4 is provided without any of these scores shown.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 normalizes the score increments and decrements according to the interval between measurements. Therefore, the table below also stores the number of TDMA frames which have occurred between measurements to normalize the interference scores as described in more detail below.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to operate on any of the available four hundred sixteen "A" side or "B" side pairs of uplink and downlink frequencies in the cellular frequency bands.
  • the cellular network 16 offers the cordless cellular base station 10 a list, or range of frequencies, carved out of the cellular frequency bands within which to operate.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 once authorized by the cellular network 16 with such a frequency list supplied, does not update or otherwise maintain the scores of frequencies which are not on the network-supplied list of frequencies that the cordless cellular base station 10 is enabled to use.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 Since measurement rates are not uniform over time, the cordless cellular base station 10 must normalize the score increments and decrements according to the interval between measurements. The score updating process requires the cordless cellular base station 10 to track the update rate.
  • the update rate is expressed as the number N of 40 ms TDMA frames since the last interference measurements on any given frequency. Any one frequency may have different update rates from different measurement sources. The range of possible values for N is limited depending upon the measurement mode, as described below.
  • N The value of N will, in general, be different for measurements made by the cordless cellular base station 10, the first mobile station 12, and the second mobile station 12.
  • the value of N depends on the measurement mode, and can be calculated as indicated in Table 5 below.
  • the following abbreviations are used in the table: (1) f od is the operating downlink frequency; (2) f QU is the operating uplink frequency; (3) f 1( f 2 and f 3 are the three backup frequencies; (4) n b is the number of backup frequencies; (5) n )ow is the number of allowed frequencies other than f 0 -f 3 which have scores less than Lt; and (6) n hiph is the number of allowed frequencies other than f -f 3 which have scores greater than or equal to Lt.
  • cordless cellular Number N of TDMA frames base station mode since the last measurement cordless cellular base mobile station 1 mobile station 2 station
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on the operating frequency f od once every two frames, except that 1 of 8 such measurements is preempted by an idle code transmission as described above. This pre-emption of downlink measurements accounts for the divisor 0.875 here and elsewhere in the cordless cellular base station 10 column of the table.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures uplink interference of the operating frequency f ou once per frame. Since these measurements do not occur in Time Slot 4, they are never preempted for an idle code transmission, thus N is 1.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on one of the downlink backup frequencies f-
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on one of the allowed frequencies with scores equal to or greater than Lt. This means an average of 20/0.875 frames between non-preempted measurements, or 20n hj _ h /0.875 frames before all these frequencies can be measured once.
  • the mobile station's measurements in active (conversation) mode are listed in the third row, second cell of the above table. These values assume an average of three seconds (IS- 136's allowable range is two to ten seconds) between successive MAHO reports.
  • the measurements are as follows: One indirect measurement of downlink interference on the operating frequency every 75 frames (- three seconds) is taken. For this measurement, the cordless cellular base station 10 combines the mobile station's downlink WER and downlink RSS results using the equation described above to achieve the noise plus interference measurement. One direct measurement of downlink interference on each backup frequency is taken every 75 frames. As described above, all downlink backup frequencies are on every MAHO list. Every 75 frames, measurements of downlink interference on seven of the allowed frequencies on the MAHO list with scores below Lt are taken.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 uses its interference scores as the input to its decisions to select, retain, or abandon an operating frequency or a backup frequency. Changes in operating or backup frequencies result from the score on the frequency exceeding a specified threshold.
  • the two thresholds used by the cordless cellular base station 10 are the high threshold, Ht, and the low threshold, Lt.
  • Ht is set to Ymax' 2 ' e 1 ual t0 2 21 - a ⁇ d
  • Lt is set t0 Y max' 8
  • the low and high thresholds are set to be equal.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 forms a ranked list of 4M, or four times M, downlink frequencies with the lowest acceptable interference scores from the above list of all frequency scores. Only downlink frequencies whose interference scores are below the High Threshold (Ht) are eligible for inclusion in this list. Therefore, under some conditions the list will contain fewer than 4M frequencies. In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 recompiles this ranked list every two seconds.
  • Ht High Threshold
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 also maintains an unranked list of all frequencies with interference scores less than a Low Threshold (Lt). In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 recompiles this list at least once every two seconds.
  • Figure 21 shows a simplified example of the interference score 290 for a particular frequency (note this example does not take into consideration the status of a call or if a primary mobile station is registered with the cordless cellular base station).
  • the interference score rises above Lt the cordless cellular base station 10 would abandon this frequency if this were the operating frequency and if the other scores were below Lt.
  • Ht when the interference score rises above Ht, this frequency is unconditionally rejected for use as either an operating or backup frequency.
  • the interference score decays below Ht, this frequency once again becomes eligible for selection as a backup or operating frequency.
  • the initial downlink operating frequency is preferably the frequency on the authorized frequency list with the lowest interference score, namely the frequency at the top of the ranked list. If fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 will preferably not begin transmitting and will alert the CCBS VLR of the problem.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 evaluates the new score to decide whether or not to change the operating frequency.
  • the rules for changing the operating frequency also depend upon whether the primary mobile stations are registered or if a call is in progress. Thus, in the preferred embodiment, if the cordless cellular base station's primary mobile station 12 is in active or standby mode or if any of the registered mobile stations are on a call,: the cordless cellular base station 10 will no longer operate on the current operating frequency if: its interference score equals or exceeds Lt and if the first backup frequency's interference score is lower than the operating frequency's score.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 will no longer operate on the current operating frequency if: its interference score equals or exceeds Ht, otherwise, the cordless cellular base station will remain on its current operating frequency until the primary mobile station user registers with the cordless cellular base station or the interference level exceeds Ht. This feature is provided, so that the primary user's phone can automatically locate its cordless cellular base station 10 when it comes into proximity with it.
  • DTC digital traffic channel
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 were frequently changing its operating frequency when the primary mobile station was not registered, it would be possible for the mobile station 12 to change frequencies such that the current operational frequency was not on the list of the operating and backup frequencies that the mobile station 12 stored when it last registered with the cordless cellular base station 10.
  • the primary mobile station would not be able to automatically locate and register with the cordless cellular base station 10, because it would not be aware of the current operating frequency of the base station 10, and would therefore not know where to look for its new frequency. In this situation, the user would need to manually invoke a test registration by the mobile station.
  • the replacement operating frequency is the first backup frequency f j . If a call is active at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 abandons the operating frequency, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably performs a handoff to the new frequency, using a handoff procedure known to those of skill in the art. However, in a typical handoff the mobile station would be switching from one cell to another. In the case of a handoff initiated by the cordless cellular base station, the mobile station remains in the same cell (the cordless cellular base station cell) and changes its operating frequencies.
  • the handoff procedure is carefully controlled to ensure that the transceiver does not lose the call while it tunes to the new frequency. If a call is not in progress, the cordless cellular base station 10 will change its operating frequency to the first backup frequency f-
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably contacts the CCBS VLR and informs the CCBS VLR that it does not have enough clear channels for operation.
  • the CCBS VLR may send the cordless cellular base station an new set of channels, or may send it a lower M value, or may send the cordless cellular base station an empty list of authorized frequencies which will cause it to cease transmission until a new set of authorized frequencies are provided.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 will make its own measurements and maintain interference scores for the newly supplied list of authorized frequencies. Once there are M or more frequencies with scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 begins transmitting on one of the frequencies with an interference score below Ht.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 abandons its operating frequency, fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 ceases to transmit its DCCH.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 will make its own measurements and maintain interference scores, regularly and frequently checking the number of frequencies whose scores are below Ht.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 randomly chooses a waiting time, uniformly distributed between 0 and 5 minutes. After this waiting time expires, and provided that there are still M or more frequencies with scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 begins transmitting, preferably on the frequency with the lowest score.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 In order to avoid dropping a call in progress, the cordless cellular base station 10 temporarily sets M-1 while a digital traffic channel (DTC) is in use. When the call ends (i.e., when neither DTC is in use), the cordless cellular base station 10 will reset M to its true value. If the cordless cellular base station 10 changed its operating frequency during the call, the cordless cellular base station 10 applies the following congestion test after the end of the call: If fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably contacts the CCBS VLR and informs the CCBS VLR that it does not have enough clear channels for operation.
  • DTC digital traffic channel
  • the CCBS VLR may send the cordless cellular base station a new set of channels, or may send a lower M value, or may send the cordless cellular base station an empty list of frequencies which will cause it to cease transmission until a new set of authorized frequencies are provided.
  • Initial Selection and Reselection of Backup Freouencies For both initial and subsequent selection, the cordless cellular base station 10 chooses each backup frequency equiprobably from the top 2M (two times M) frequencies in the ranked list of the best acceptable frequencies maintained in the cordless cellular base station 10 score table. The operating frequency is removed from the ranked list before the backup frequency is chosen.
  • the reason that the backup frequencies are equiprobably chosen from the list of possible frequencies rather than being chosen deterministically is that it prevents two neighboring cordless cellular base stations from selecting the same set of backup frequencies. If the best interference scores where chosen, it would be highly likely that two neighboring cordless cellular base stations would have similarly ranked interference score measurements for similar channels. If similar backup frequencies were chosen for neighboring cordless cellular base stations, the chances of the neighboring cordless cellular base stations selecting the same frequency as their new operation frequency and resulting in the occurrence of a collision would be very high. By equiprobably choosing the backup frequencies from the list of suitable frequencies, the chances of two neighboring cordless cellular base stations having the same set of backup frequency is greatly lessened.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 evaluates the new score to decide whether or not to change this backup frequency. If the interference score of a backup frequency exceeds Ht or exceeds the (4M)-th position in the overall ranking, the cordless cellular base station 10 replaces this backup frequency. When replacing a backup frequency, the cordless cellular base station 10 maintains the ordering of the backup frequency list ⁇ f-, f 2 , f 3 ⁇ for proper ordering in the broadcast neighbor list. The replacement backup frequency becomes f 3 . If the old f 3 was not replaced, it becomes f 2 . If the old f 2 was not replaced, it becomes
  • the score for the operating frequency (a) exceeds Lt.
  • the first backup frequency (b), which has a lower score than does frequency (a) becomes the new operating frequency.
  • the second backup moves up to first position, and the former operating frequency (a) is chosen as the replacement backup frequency.
  • the score for the second backup frequency (a) exceeds Ht and it is therefore removed from the backup list.
  • the score for the operating frequency (b) exceeds Lt and in the preferred embodiment, the primary mobile station is registered with the cordless cellular base station.
  • the first backup frequency (c) which has a lower score than does frequency (b), becomes the new operating frequency. Due to the intermittent or weak nature of the interference, the interference score for the former operating frequency (b) it still below Ht. Therefore frequency (b) is chosen as the replacement backup frequency.
  • the score for the first backup frequency (b) exceeds Ht and it is therefore removed from the backup list. This leaves only one frequency with an acceptable score. Although this would seem to violate the rule that the minimum number of frequencies below Ht (M) must be at least 2, this constraint is only enforced at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 changes its operating frequency. For intermittent or weak interference, the constraint is M-1 acceptable frequencies for continued operation, versus M acceptable frequencies for initial operation. Thus the cordless cellular base station 10 continues to transmit at time t g .
  • frequency (a) becomes acceptable and is added as the first backup.
  • frequency (b) becomes acceptable and is added as the second backup.
  • the quick start feature enables the cordless cellular base station 10 to quickly become operable using a few frequencies, referred to as "quick start frequencies", supplied by the cellular network 16 which are known to be clear channels in the area where the cordless cellular base station is located.
  • the goal for the use of the quick start frequencies is to get the cordless cellular base station operating quickly using these dedicated frequencies and then to migrate them off of these frequencies to other channels as they are found to be clear.
  • these cordless cellular base station downlink frequencies are set aside by the registered cellular network to permit the use of the cordless cellular base station as a sort of safe haven.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 is sent two sets of frequencies.
  • the first set is a short list of frequencies known to be clear by the cellular network 16, referred to as quick start frequencies," which are provided with a low initial interference score.
  • the second set is a large set of frequencies with high initial interference scores.
  • the initialization score for the quick start frequencies is at least close to the high threshold Ht.
  • the quick start frequencies will quickly become available for use as an operating frequency as their score will continue to decrement, since the frequency is clear, until at least one of the frequencies falls below the high threshold (Ht) and can be used as the initial operating frequency.
  • the initialization score for the quick start frequencies is below the high threshold Ht, so all of the quick start frequencies will immediately be available for use as the operating frequency.
  • the cellular network 16 will provide an initial value M j for M, the minimum number of clear channels the cordless cellular base station needs to operate.
  • M is equal to the number of quick start frequencies provided. This scheme would be useful in a spectrally congested are such as a tall building.
  • the cellular network 16 After a specified period of time X, the cellular network 16 will try to migrate the cordless cellular base station 10 off the quick start frequencies. In the preferred embodiment, this period of time X will be forty-eight hours. During the next network update (either a location update or a network cancellation) after the expiration of X, the cellular network 16 will increase M to M n , the requirement for the minimum number of clear channels for the cordless cellular base station to maintain operation. This information is given to the cordless cellular base station in an authorization message which is sent back from the cellular network to the cordless cellular base station 10 after the location update or network cancellation process has been completed as described in more detail above.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 If the cordless cellular base station 10 does not have the minimum number of operating frequencies, it will send an alarm message to the cellular network 16. At this point, the cellular network will allow the cordless cellular base station 10 to operate with both sets of frequencies until M j can be increased to n and the cordless cellular base station has enough cellular frequencies for operation. If the cordless cellular base station 10 has the required number of operating frequencies, the cellular network may remove the original "quick start frequencies" and allow it operate on the remaining ciear channels. It will remove the "quick start frequencies" during the next network update exchange using the authorization message. The authorization message will include only the second set of frequencies, i.e., excluding the "quick start frequencies," and a new M value equal to M n -M j .
  • the cordless cellular base station periodically initiates a phone call to the CCBS VLR.
  • the cordless cellular base station 10 advantageously downloads all of the stored interference scores measured using the above described algorithm for all of its authorized frequencies.
  • the CCBS VLR forwards the interference score information to a data collection node (DCN) in the cellular network.
  • DCN data collection node
  • the CCBS VLR periodically sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message with the telephone number for the data collection node instead of the telephone number for the location update information.
  • the cordless cellular base station calls the new telephone number and reports the interference data directly to the data collection node.
  • the CCBS VLR sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message to reinstate the telephone number to report its location update messages.
  • the data collection node sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message to reinstate the telephone number of the CCBS VLR to report its location update messages.
  • the cellular network can use these interference scores to assist in learning about the peak interference periods for the cell containing the CCBS. Further, the interference scores are useful in assigning or re ⁇ assigning the operational frequencies for the regional cells.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)

Abstract

A mobile station communicates with both a cellular network (16), by which it is assigned a mobile identification number, and to a cordless cellular base station (10) utilizing the same cellular frequency range and communications protocol. When the mobile station comes within range of a cordless cellular base station, it deregisters automatically from the cellular network and registers with the cordless cellular base station.

Description

WIRELESS COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Field of the Invention The invention relates to a digital wireless communication system. In particular, the invention relates to cordless telephones and cellular networks. Background
A common type of wireless communication is the communication which occurs between a cordless telephone handset and its associated base unit within a limited distance range around the user's home or business. Cordless telephones typically operate over a radio frequency (RF) portion of the spectrum set aside for general public use. Also, the power of the cordless phone signal is lower than other communication signals, because the signal needs to only be transmitted between the cordless handset and the associated base unit within the home or business of the user. Therefore, there is no user license from the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) required to operate a cordless telephone. Ultimately the communication is carried from the associated base unit along a landline on the public telephone network to the connecting party; therefore the cost of the telephone call is regulated by the LEC which owns the public switched telephone network (PSTN). Another method of wireless communication is a regional cellular communication network which is operated by a cellular operator to enable the transmission of voice and data from a mobile station to a cellular base station over a specific band of frequencies, e.g., 824-849 MHz and 869-894 MHz, under license by the FCC. The bands are generally broken up into transmission channels and reception channels which each employ different bands of frequencies in the cellular spectrum. Cellular transmissions from the base station to the mobile station occupies the spectrum between 824 and 849 MHz with each transmission channel occupying about 30 KHz. Cellular reception from the mobile stations to the base stations generally occupy the spectrum between 869 and 894 MHz with each reception channel occupying about 30 KHz. As is well known to those of ordinary skill in the art, each of the transmission and reception bands are divided between two cellular service providers in each market and are referred to as "A" and "B" bands. Thus, each provider operates four hundred and sixteen pairs of transmission and reception frequency channels on which to provide service. Twenty-one of the four hundred and sixteen frequency channels pairs are ordinarily used as control channels to send control signals from the base station to the mobile station, thus only three hundred and ninety-five channels are actually available to transmit calls between the cellular base station and mobile station. The cellular service provider enlists subscribers who are authorized to communicate via the regional cellular network. Each subscriber must purchase a mobile station or handset which is capable of communication with the regional cellular network. The handset, at the time of manufacture, is assigned an electronic serial number (ESN). The ESN is generally stored in the permanent memory, such as an EEPROM, in the handset. The subscriber registers the mobile station with the regional cellular network and the mobile station is assigned a mobile identification number (MIN) by which the mobile station can be accessed. As the price of mobile stations decreases and the cost of air time decreases, the number of users that subscribe to regional cellular networks is increasing. Recently, handsets have been disclosed which are capable of switching between communication with a cellular network and with an RF cordless telephone unit. Once the handset is in the proximity of the cordless telephone unit, the telephone unit is capable of receiving calls from both the public switched telephone network (via the RF cordless telephone unit) and the regional cellular network. Since the cellular and RF cordless communication systems utilize different frequency bands for communication, a handset that can communicate with both cellular and RF cordless base stations requires some significant additional hardware and software. In practice, a handset that can communicate with both types of base stations requires one transceiver that can communicate with cordless frequencies and one transceiver that can communicate with cellular frequencies as well as separate interface hardware between each transceiver and the main handset controlling hardware. Further, the main handset controlling hardware must be able to recognize and communicate with the different communications protocols required to communicate with the RF cordless telephone base station and with the cellular networks. The additional hardware required to communicate with both base stations increases the size and the weight of the handset. Further, the additional hardware increases the cost of the handset in a highly price-competitive market.
Summary The preferred embodiment of the present invention comprises a wireless communication system. The wireless communication system is capable of communicating with a cellular network compatible mobile unit, also referred to as a mobile station herein. The cordless cellular base station, also referred to as a subregioπal base station, is preferably connected to a landline on a public switched telephone network and is assigned a landline number or phone number. The mobile station is registered with a cellular network and is assigned a mobile identification number. Advantageously, the mobile station is capable of communication with both a conventional regional cellular base station and to the cordless cellular base station utilizing the same cellular frequency range and communications protocol. When the mobile station is communicating with the cellular network, it is referred to as being in the regional cellular service mode. When the mobile station is communicating with the cordless cellular base station, it is referred to as being in cordless cellular telephone landline service mode. The mobile station of the present invention advantageously communicates with the autonomous base station and with the regional cellular base stations of the cellular network utilizing the same frequency range and the same communications protocol. In a preferred embodiment, the communications protocol that is utilized is compliant with the IS-136, parts one and two, air interface standard which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. The IS- 136, parts one and two, standard is available from the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Dept., 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. This standard provides in part for TDMA (time division multiple access) digital communications and is well known to those of skill in the art. The IS- 136 standard is designed to ensure compatibility between cellular mobile telecommunication systems so that a mobile station can obtain service in any cellular system manufactured in accordance with the standard. Since the mobile station communicates with the cordless cellular base station and with the regional cellular base stations of the cellular network utilizing the same frequency range and the same communications protocol, the mobile station may be manufactured using similar hardware, such as a digital transceiver, and similar software to communicate with both the cordless cellular base station and the cellular network. Therefore, the overall size and the weight of the mobile station is not increased compared to conventional cellular telephones which are compatible with the IS- 136 standard. Further, by reducing the amount of additional hardware and additional software necessary, the cost of the mobile station of the preferred embodiment is not much higher than conventional IS- 136 compliant mobile stations. The cordless cellular base station is able to communicate with the mobile station and act as a conduit between the mobile station and the public switched telephone network. Further, despite the fact the mobile station is IS-136 compliant and can communicate with both analog and digital regional cells, the mobile station preferably communicates with the cordless cellular base station utilizing a digital control channel and corresponding digital traffic channels. By utilizing a digital channels, rather than analog and digital channels for communication with the mobile station, the hardware and software required to operate the cordless cellular base station is further reduced and thus the manufacturing costs are reduced.
In one aspect of the present invention, once a mobile station receives registration privileges with a particular cordless cellular base station, the mobile station automatically registers with the cordless cellular base station when the mobile station comes into proximity with the cordless cellular base station. As the number of cordless cellular base station users increases it becomes more likely that at least some cordless cellular base stations will be operating in close proximity to one another. With base stations present in adjoining houses, for example, it is not desirable to enable automatic registration for all mobile station users that come into proximity with a cordless cellular base station, because it is possible for one neighbor to inadvertently automatically register with another neighbor's cellular base station. Advantageously, the automatic registration feature of the present invention allows the cordless cellular base station to restrict automatic registration to those users who have been previously pre-registered with a particular cordless cellular base station. By requiring preregistratioπ, before automatic registration occurs, accidental automatic registration with a nearby cordless cellular base station is prevented while still providing the convenience of automatic registration for frequent users. In addition, the mobile station will not attempt to automatically register with a cordless cellular base station unless it has previously registered with that cordless cellular base station and knows on which channels to look for the cordless cellular base station.
In another aspect of the present invention, the cordless cellular base station maintains a cordless cellular base station registration list in a semipermanent portion of memory which stores the mobile system identification number of the mobile stations which have been previously been granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station. In another aspect of the present invention, when a mobile station which is not presently involved in a call comes within range of a cordless cellular base station with which it has previously registered, in accordance with the preferred embodiment, it automatically switches from regional cellular service mode to cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention. In another aspect of the present invention, the cordless cellular base station can process up to two active mobile stations at the same time. When two mobile stations are listed as active, the cordless cellular base station bridges the audio signal for the two mobile stations together such that each of the mobile stations is acting like an extension on a normal landline. The cordless cellular base station is designed to operate in the residential home or small office environment. This active RF environment can be potentially very noisy because there may be no dedicated frequency spectrum allocated for the cordless cellular base station operation coupled with the fact that the frequency usage is not explicitly coordinated with the regional cellular network planning. The cordless cellular base station has to co-exist in the same cellular band used by the regional cellular network and views the regional cellular network as a source of background interference. The cordless cellular base station attempts to avoid the potential interference by the cellular network by choosing frequencies which, as far as the cordless cellular base station can determine, are not being used by nearby regional cells or by other nearby cordless cellular base stations. In another aspect of the present invention, the cordless cellular base station implements an avoidance mechanism which scans the frequencies in the cellular band and determines the best and next-best cellular frequencies for communication with the cellular network at all times.
The cordless cellular base station measures the potential interference on each channel and uses the interference measurements to form a score which is used in making the choice of an operating frequency. By selecting a frequency from those with the lowest interference scores, and by using appropriate channel abandonment thresholds, the cordless cellular base station attempts to avoid transmitting on any frequency which is already in use nearby the public or private cellular network or by other cordless cellular base stations within range. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station selects for its initial operational frequency, the frequency with the lowest interference score. The cordless cellular base station randomly selects for its backup frequencies, a specified number of downlink frequencies whose scores are below a high threshold value (Ht). Depending upon whether a call is in progress or whether a primary mobile station is registered, if the interference score of the current operational frequency rises above a first low threshold (Lt) or above the high threshold (Ht), the cordless cellular base station automatically switches its operational frequency to the first backup frequency as described in more detail below. The cordless cellular base station also removes backup frequencies from the back-up frequency list if the interference score for that backup frequency rises above the high threshold (Ht). In another aspect of the present invention, the cordless cellular base station needs to locate a specified number of frequencies having score values below the high threshold value (Ht).
In another aspect of the present invention, in order to make the above measurements, the cordless cellular base station is designed to only transmit a half rate digital control channel (DCCH). Therefore, time slot 4 of the TDMA frame is not used to transmit DCCH information. When the cordless cellular base station is authorized for use and none of its registered mobile stations are processing a call, i.e., are in an active state, the cordless cellular base station performs an interference measurement during time slot 4 of the cordless cellular base station transmit time frame. When there are no calls being processed by the cordless cellular base station, the receiver will be silent on timeslot 5 of the receive time frame; and if the transmitter does not transmit any information on timeslot 4 of the transmit time frame, the cordless cellular base station will not be generating any of its own interference and thus can make an accurate measurement of the interference generated on its own channel. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station performs interference measurements on both its receive or uplink frequencies and on its transmit or downlink frequencies.
Brief Description of the Drawings Figure 1 is a schematic block diagram of a cordless cellular system of the preferred embodiment in communication with a cellular network and a public switched telephone network and shown in use with a cellular network compatible mobile unit.
Figure 2 is a partial schematic block diagram of a cordless cellular system of the preferred embodiment in communication with a plurality of cellular network compatible mobile units and a public switched telephone network. Figure 3 is a block diagram of the cordless cellular base station hardware of the preferred embodiment. Figure 4 is a schematic diagram of the TDMA time slot usage for a cordless cellular base station receive frame and for a cordless cellular base station transmit frame.
Figure 5 is a block diagram of the mobile station hardware of the preferred embodiment. Figure 6 is a schematic diagram of a memory storage table in the mobile station which stores data regarding certain cordless cellular base stations with which the mobile station communicates. Figure 7 is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with the cordless cellular base station initial authorization feature.
Figure 8 is a schematic diagram of the registration list which is maintained by the cordless cellular base station.
Figure 9 is a diagram illustrating the communication between the cordless cellular base station and the mobile station associated with an initial registration of a mobile station.
Figure 10 is a flow chart illustrating the steps that the cordless cellular base station takes to process an initial registration request.
Figure 11 is a fiow chart illustrating the steps that the mobile station takes to determine its location before attempting automatic registration with a cordless cellular base station. Figure 12 is a flow chart illustrating the automatic registration of a mobile station to a cordless cellular base station.
Figure 13 is a flow chart illustrating the network update attempt procedure of the cordless cellular base station.
Figure 14a is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with one embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network update of forwarding feature.
Figure 14b is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with an alternate embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network update of forwarding feature.
Figure 15 is a schematic block diagram of the communications between the cordless cellular base station and the cellular network to forward calls for the mobile stations serviced by the cordless cellular base station. Figure 16 is a schematic block diagram illustrating one embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station. Figure 17 is a schematic block diagram illustrating a second embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station.
Figure 18 is a schematic block diagram illustrating a third embodiment of the extension voice combining circuitry of the cordless cellular base station. Figure 19a is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with one embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network cancellation of forwarding feature.
Figure 19b is a diagram illustrating the steps associated with an alternate embodiment of the cordless cellular base station network cancellation of forwarding feature.
Figure 20 is a graph of the staircase function used to translate the noise plus interference power level into a score increment.
Figure 21 is a graph of the variations in an exemplary interference score over time. Figure 22 is a drawing of an exemplary score of a variety of frequencies over time. Detailed Description of the Preferred Embodiments General Description of System Operation The preferred embodiment of the wireless communication system of the present invention, as illustrated in
Figures 1 and 2, comprises a cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station is capable of communicating with a cellular network compatible mobile station 12. The cordless cellular base station 10, algor referred to as a limited or selective access base station, is connected to a landline 14 on a public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15 and is assigned a landline identification number (LLN) or telephone number. Further, the cordless cellular base station 10 is assigned an electronic serial number at the time of manufacture for identification purposes. The electronic serial number is generally stored in permanent memory in the cordless cellular base station so the serial number cannot be tampered with by unauthorized personnel. The mobile station 12 is registered with a cellular network 16 and is assigned a mobile station identification number (MIN) which is the telephone number of the mobile station. Further, the mobile station, at the time of manufacture, is assigned an electronic serial number (ESN). The ESN is generally stored in the permanent memory, in the mobile station. As is known to those of skill in the art, the cellular network 16 is connected to the public switched telephone network to route calls to/from callers on the cellular network 16 from/to callers on the public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15.
The mobile stations 12 are capable of communicating with both cellular base stations 18 on the cellular network 16 and with cordless cellular base stations 10. When a mobile station 12 is communicating with the cellular network 16, it is referred to as being in regional cellular service mode. When a mobile station 12 is communicating with the cordless cellular base station 10, it is referred to as being in cordless telephone landline service mode.
When a mobile station 12 comes within range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered, as described in more detail below and in accordance with the preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 automatically switches from the regional cellular service mode to the cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention. Once the mobile station 12 has confirmed with the cordless cellular base station 10 that the mobile station 12 has switched to cordless landline service mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 communicates with the cellular network 16 to provide a call forwarding update message. The call forwarding update message requests that the cellular network 16 route all calls for the mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. In addition, while the mobile station 12 remains within range of the cordless cellular base station 10, all calls placed on the mobile station 12 are sent through the cordless cellular base station 10 to the associated landline 14 and out onto the PSTN 15. Preferably, there is no handoff of telephone calls between the regional cellular network 16 and cordless cellular base station 10 environments. For example, if a call is initiated via the cordless cellular base station 10 and the mobile station 12 moves to an area outside of the range of the cordless cellular base station's cell 17, the call is disconnected instead of being transferred to the cellular network 16. In an alternate embodiment, handoff of telephone calls between the regional cellular network 16 and cordless cellular base station 10 environments is enabled. For example, if a call is initiated via the cordless cellular base station 10 and the mobile station 12 moves to an area outside of the range of the cordless cellular base station's cell 17, the call is automatically switched through the cordless cellular base station 10 and its associated landline 14 to the cellular network 16. The cellular network 16 then routes the call through the cellular base station 10 to the user's mobile station 12 in a manner similar to the handoff procedure between adjacent cells in a conventional cellular system.
Typically, when the mobile station 12 severs contact with the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 is informed during the initial authorization message which types of registration/deregistration activities for which the network 16 wants to be informed. Some examples of types of deregistration events for which the network 16 may want to be contacted are: when the mobile station 12 is turned off, i.e., a power down deregistration or due to a manual cancellation of the cordless service mode, i.e., forced deregistration. When the mobile station 12 severs contact with the cordless cellular base station 10 for reasons other than powering off, the mobile station 12 may register with the local regional cellular base station of the regional cellular network 16. Once the mobile station 12 is registered with the regional cell, calls to the users mobile identification number are directiy routed by the cellular network 16 to the mobile station 12.
Cordless Cellular Base Station
Cordless Cellular Base Station (CCBS) Hardware
The cordless cellular base station 10 communicates over the land line 14 and with the mobile station 12 using a digital cellular transceiver. The cordless cellular base station uses time division multiple access (TDMA) communication to communicate with the mobile station 12. In a preferred embodiment, the hardware of the cordless cellular base station 10 is very similar to the hardware used for a mobile station, however the functionality of the cordless cellular base station 16 is similar to a base station for a regional cell. The most significant differences between the cordless cellular base station and a typical base station are that the cordless cellular base station preferably has only one transceiver (permitting the use of only one set of transmit and receive frequency channel at one time) and that it supports only digital traffic. These differences permit the cordless cellular base station to be configured in a reasonable size for home use. As illustrated in Figure 3, the CCBS comprises a microprocessor or a microcontroller 20, an associated memory storage area 21, a baseband modem 22, a cellular transceiver 23, a transmit (Tx) antenna 24, a receive (Rx) antenna 25, user interface hardware 26, a modem 27, a switch 28 and standard telephone interface hardware 29. The processor 20 is in communication with the memory 21, the user interface 26, the modem 27, the baseband modem 22, and the cellular transceiver 23 in a well known way. The processor 20 controls the operation of the radio portion of the cordless cellular base station hardware, i.e., the operation of the baseband modem 22 and cellular transceiver 23. The processor 20 also controls the operation of the call processing tasks and the administrative tasks related to communication with the cellular network 16. Finally, the processor 20 controls the user interface 26. Preferably, the digital cellular transceiver 23 and processor 20 together communicate with the mobile station utilizing the IS- 136 standard air interface communications protocol. The associated memory storage area 21 comprises both permanent and temporary memory storage capabilities.
The baseband modem 22 is preferably implemented using a digital signal processor (DSP). Preferably, the baseband modem 22 used in the cordless cellular base station 10 provides the same type of function as is used in local cellular base stations 18. The baseband modem 22 is used to implement the time division multiple access (TDMA) protocol in accordance with the IS- 136 standard. Further, the baseband modem 22 performs the coding of the voice signals which digitally compresses and encodes the analog voice messages to/from the landline from/to the mobile station for faster transmission across the cellular channel, as known to those of skill in the art. In the preferred embodiment, VSELP coding is used; however, other compressing and coding schemes known to those of skill in the art, such as the International Telecommunications Union (ITU) compression and coding schemes, may be utilized. Finally, the baseband modem 22 performs the signal processing functions associated with voice detection to differentiate between noise and voice signals and echo cancellation to alleviate echoes picked up by the microphone in the mobile stations 12 which are common signal processing functions performed by base stations.
The cellular transceiver 23 comprises a transmitter (Tx) 30 and a receiver (Rx) 31. In a preferred embodiment, the cellular transceiver 23 is a digital transceiver. In a more preferred embodiment, the digital cellular transceiver 23 is a time division multiple access (TDMA) transceiver. Preferably, the transmitter 30 is the similar to the transmitter that is used in the mobile station 12. Preferably, the functionality of the transmitter is compliant with the IS-138 minimum performance requirements for a digital base station standard except for the exceptions listed below. The IS- 138 standard is well known to those of skill in the art and is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. The IS- 138 standard can be obtained through the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Department, 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. The first exception is that the transmitter of the cordless cellular base station emits much less power than a standard cellular base station, since the output power of the cordless cellular base station 10 is designed to communicate only with mobile stations 12 in a small surrounding area. Preferably, the transmitter 30 transmits at an output power of 6.3 mW. In another embodiment, the transmitter 30 transmits at an output power of approximately 10 W. Additional exceptions for the transceiver to the IS-138 standard are that the frequency tolerance of the cordless cellular base station is 1.0 parts per million (ppm) and that time slot 4 is usually silent except for the transmission of the synch word as described in more detail below. The receiver 31 is similar to the receivers that are used in a standard cellular telephone, in that the receiver 31 of the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to receive at a fairly high sensitivity in the mobile receive band in order to be able to search for other nearby base station signals. Advantageously, a single receiver is used to both receive the mobile station transmissions and to take noise measurements which saves in the cost of the cordless cellular base station and reduces the size of the cordless cellular base station. In the preferred embodiment, the dynamic range of the receiver is approximately 70 dB, that is, the receiver can receive signals which are within a 70 dB range. In order to accurately receive the signals from the mobile station 12, the sensitivity of the receiver 31 on the cordless cellular base station 10 must be significantly less than the sensitivity to measure the noise in the surrounding environment. This is because the mobile station is expected to be used very close to the base station. Thus, when the receiver 31 is waiting to receive a mobile station transmission, the sensitivity of the receiver is less to enable it to receive higher powered transmissions. In the preferred embodiment, the 70 dB dynamic range of the receiver is scaled to receive transmissions from the mobile station 12 in the -20 dBm to -90 dBm range. When the receiver 31 is waiting to take an interference measurement, the sensitivity of the receiver 31 is increased to enable it to receive lower power transmissions. In the preferred embodiment, the 70 dB dynamic range of the receiver 31 is scaled to receive transmissions in the 46 dBm to -116 dBm range. In an alternate embodiment, the CCBS uses a non-linear front end receiver to provide increased dynamic range. As will be recognized by those of skill in the art, the fact that the CCBS does not require an equalizer enables the non-linear front end receiver to be easily substituted for the preferred receiver described above.
By utilizing only a digital transceiver 23 to communicate with the mobile station 12, the hardware and software of the cordless cellular base station 10 is less complicated and therefore, the cost to manufacture the cordless cellular base station 10 is reduced. The IS-136 standard calls for base station and mobile stations that operate in TDMA digital mode on the digital channels and in an analog mode on analog channels. While it is preferred to provide cordless cellular base station that operates only in a digital mode on the digital channels, it is contemplated that a cordless cellular base station could be provided such that it operates in both analog and digital modes. The transmit (Tx) antenna 24 and receive (Rx) antenna 25 are simple antennas, since the coverage area for the cordless cellular base station 10 is small. In a preferred embodiment, the transmit antenna 24 and receive antenna 25 are separate antennas which are physically separated on the cordless cellular base station 10 . Further, their signals are transmitted to the transceiver 23 along separate paths to eliminate the need for a duplexer, thereby simplifying the design and reducing manufacturing costs. However, it is contemplated that in some cases a common antenna for both transmission and receive functions may be advantageous and in the common antenna embodiment a duplexer is added to the cordless cellular base station hardware. Duplexers are well known devices that permit signais of different frequencies to be sent and received at the same time over the same antenna. In one embodiment, the transmit and receive antennas are internal antennas that do not extend outside of the cordless cellular base station.
The user interface hardware 26 is capable of providing an interface between a keypad 32 and a display 33. In a preferred embodiment, the keypad 32 includes the standard telephone twelve-key keypad. In other embodiments, the keypad 32 may include additional function keys. The display 33 is preferably an LCD display capable of displaying a variety of types of information to the user. The display 33 in a simpler embodiment may include a plurality of seven-segment displays or one or more simple LEDs. The standard telephone interface hardware 29 is utilized to communicate with the landline 14 and the PSTN 15 utilizing control signals and a communications protocol which are commonly known in the art. Preferably, the standard telephone interface hardware 29 includes a standard four-wire-to-two wire hybrid device to convert the signals on four wires from the cordless cellular base station hardware to the two wire standard of landline communication. In addition, the telephone interface hardware 29 provides ring detection and the closing of a subscriber loop under command of the controller 20. In a preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 appears to the PSTN 15 as if it were a standard 2500 series telephone. Thus, for example, the base station 10 advantageously supports both pulse and DTMF dialing. The cordless cellular base station 10 also includes a standard data modem 27 for use in transmitting data over an ordinary telephone line. This permits a modem link to be set up between the cordless cellular base station 10 and another system using its associated landline 14.
Finally, the cordless cellular base station hardware includes a power supply 34. The power supply 34 comprises the circuits to define and regulate voltages supplied to the above-referenced hardware elements of the cordless cellular base station 10. At least one connection is made to obtain power from a main source, such as a wall socket in a home. The power supply 34 may also include an alternate connection to which a battery may be connected and charged. Cordless Cellular Base Station Operation Referring back to Figures 1 and 2, the cordless cellular base station 10 supports the following functions, which are described in more detail hereafter. A network authorization procedure initializes the communication between the cordless cellular base station 10 and the cellular network 16. After the network authorization procedure is complete, the cordless cellular base station 10 enables registration of mobile stations 12 for use with the cordless cellular base station 10. Registration of a mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10, as described in more detail below, enables the mobile station 12 to receive calls addressed to its mobile station identification number at the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 maintains a list of the mobile stations 12 most recently granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10.
In the preferred embodiment, while the mobile station 12 is listed on the registration list of a particular cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 automatically registers with the cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 comes into proximity with the cordless cellular base station 10. This automatic registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10 occurs because the mobile station 12 stores information about the regional cellular network service 16 in the vicinity of the cordless cellular base station as described in more detail below. When the mobile station 12 recognizes that it is located in the portion of the regional cellular network 16 which is near the cordless cellular base station 10 that it has recently registered with, the mobile station begins to search for the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 is always transmitting a digital control channel signal (DCCH), which is well known to those of skill in the art, for the mobile station 12 to locate. Once the mobile station 12 finds the cordless cellular base station 10, an automatic registration procedure, which is described in more detail below, is invoked which enables the mobile station 12 to receive calls directed to its mobile station identification number at the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
The cordless cellular base station 10 is advantageously able to support the registration of up to ten mobile stations 12 at a given time, i.e., up to ten mobile stations 12 may be communicating with the cordless cellular base station 10 to have the regional cellular network 16 forward calls for their respective mobile stations 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. If a mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is not on a call, the mobile station 12 is considered to be in a "standby" state, that is, it is standing by ready to transmit or receive a call. When a call is received on the landline associated with the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 pages all of the registered mobile stations 12, using the paging processes known to those of skill in the art, which is the same as a cellular base station 18 paging a mobile station 12, and all of the mobile stations 12 will "ring" indicating an incoming call. To answer the incoming call, any one of the mobile station users depresses the send key on the mobile station handset 12 and will be connected through the cordless cellular base station 10 to accept the call. When the mobile station 12 accepts a call by pressing the send key or transmits a call, the mobile station 12 is considered to be in an "active" state, that is, it is actively processing a call. The cordless cellular base station of the preferred embodiment can support two "active" mobile stations, that is, up to two mobile stations can communicate with each other or with a caller on the landline through the cordless cellular base station 10. Thus, in the preferred embodiment, the first two mobile stations to answer a call will be connected to the call. The remaining mobile stations are locked out and any attempt by any of the mobile stations to answer the call will result in an error indication by the phone to the user. In order to accept more "active" mobile stations 12, additional transceivers, call processing hardware and software can be added to the cordless cellular base station 10, as known to those of skill in the art. The cordless cellular base station 10 can support two mobile stations 12 because of the manner that the cordless cellular base station 10 uses the time slots of a single TDMA frame to transmit and receive information. In accordance with the IS-136 standard, the TDMA signal has six time slots, referred to as time slot 1 to time slot 6 (37-42) respectively, and as illustrated in Figure 4. In a cordless cellular base station receive time frame 35, the following information is received by the mobile station 12 in each of the time slots (37-42), respectively. In time slot 1 (37) the cordless cellular base station 10 receives the digital control channel (DCCH) messages, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, from the mobile station 12 in the same manner that a digital cellular base station in a regional cell 18 receives DCCH messages from a mobile station 12. For example, the DCCH messages contain the information that the mobile station 12 must exchange with the cordless cellular base station 10 to maintain registration with the cordless cellular base station 12. In time slot 2 (38) and time slot 5 (41), the cordless cellular base station 10 receives voice data from a second mobile station (MS2). In time slot 3 (39) and time slot 6 (42), the cordless cellular base station 10 receives voice data from a first mobile station (MS1). In time slot 4 (40), no data is received from the mobile station 12 in the cordless cellular base station 10 which is shown as an open time slot. In a cordless cellular base station transmission time frame 36, the following information is transmitted by the cordless cellular base station 10 in each time slot, 3742, respectively. In time slot 1 (37), the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits digital control channel (DCCH) messages, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, in the same manner that a digital cellular base station in a regional cellular network transmits DCCH information. For example, the DCCH messages contain the information that the mobile station 12 looks for to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 when it recognizes that it is in proximity to it. In time slot 2 (38) and time slot 5 (41), the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits voice data to a second mobile station (MS2). In time slot 3 (39) and time slot 6 (42), the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits voice data to a first mobile station (MS1). Since the digital control channel (DCCH) is preferably a half-rate digital control channel, the DCCH does not have to be transmitted in time slot 4 (40). Therefore, time slot 4 usually only transmits the synch word which helps mobile stations synchronize their transmission with the cordless cellular base station. However, to prevent the cordless cellular base station 10 from accidentally not being detected by another cordless cellular base station 10 should their transmission be in sync the cordless cellular base station 10 randomly transmits an idle code in addition to the synch word on time slot four. By occasionally transmitting an idle code at random time intervals on time slot 4, the probability that the CCBS will be detected by any of the cordless cellular base stations which are transmitting in sync is increased. For the remainder of the time, timeslot 4 (40) is silent besides the transmission of the synch word to gather noise information regarding the environment in which the cordless cellular base station 10 resides. Thus, at randomly selected frames, the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits an idle code in Time Slot 4 (40) instead of being silent to notify nearby cordless cellular base stations 10 of its existence during this time slot 40. The average rate of these transmissions is preferably between one in two hundred fifty-six and one in eight TDMA frames. Preferably, the frames in which the idle code is transmitted are selected by either a non-deterministic process or by a pseudo-random decision process that yields different selection patterns for different cordless cellular base stations 10. When the mobile station 12 moves out of the range of the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically sends a message to the regional cellular network 16 to cancel the call forwarding of phone calls addressed to the mobile station identification number of the mobile station 12, as described in more detail below. In the preferred embodiment, if the mobile station 12 is on a call, the call is dropped and the mobile station 12 will have to reinitiate the call through the regional cellular network 16. In an alternate embodiment, the call is maintained by automatically forwarding the call to the mobile station 12 through the regional cellular network 16. In either case, after the mobile station 12 is no longer in the range of the cordless cellular network 16, the mobile station 12 automatically registers with the regional cellular network 16 to accept calls in the traditional cellular service manner.
Mobile Station Mobile Station Hardware In a preferred embodiment, the hardware of the mobile station 12, as illustrated in Figure 5, comprises a processor 46, an associated memory storage area 47, a digital cellular transceiver 50, an analog cellular transceiver 52, user interface hardware 44, and handset I/O control logic 45. Advantageously, the digital cellular transceiver 50 and the analog cellular transceiver 52 are actually incorporated into the same cellular transceiver device as in the cordless cellular base station, however, for simplicity of understanding are shown as two separate devices in Figure 5. The processor 46 is in communication with each of the above indicated elements. The associated memory storage area 47 comprises both permanent and temporary memory storage capabilities. The digital cellular transceiver 50 comprises a receiver (Rx) 48 and a transmitter (Tx) 49. In a preferred embodiment, the digital cellular transceiver 50 is a time division multiple access (TDMA) transceiver. The analog cellular transceiver 52 comprises a receiver (Rx) 53 and a transmitter (Tx) 54. The user interface hardware 50 is capable of providing an interface between a keypad 55 and a display 56. In a preferred embodiment, the keypad 55 includes at least the standard telephone twelve-key keypad. In other embodiments, the keypad 55 may include additional function keys. The display 56 is preferably an LCD display capable of displaying a variety of types of information to the user. The display 56, in a simpler embodiment, may include a plurality of seven-segment displays. The handset I/O control logic 45 provides an interface between a standard telephone microphone pickup 60 and speaker 59 on a conventional handset of a mobile station 12 as is commonly known to those in the art. Preferably, the mobile station 12 meets all of the requirements of the IS-137 performance requirements for a mobile station standard, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. The IS-137 standard can be obtained through the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), Engineering Department, 2001 Pennsylvania Avenue, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. Mobile Station Operation Referring back to Figures 1-2, the mobile station 12 preferably comprises a dual-mode cellular handset that is capable of accessing either digital or analog channels in a regional cell 18 of the cellular network 16. The mobile station 12 communicates with the cellular network 16, i.e., with the local cells 18, and with the cordless cellular base station 10 utilizing the same cellular frequency ranges and utilizing a single communications protocol. In a preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 utilizes the IS-136 air interface standard, to communicate with both the cellular network 16 and the cordless cellular base station 10. The IS-136 standard forms a compatibility standard for time division multiple access (TDMA) digital cellular mobile telecommunication systems to ensure that a mobile station 12 can obtain service in any cellular system manufactured in accordance with the standard. In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 uses only the TDMA digital protocol from the IS- 136 standard and thus, the mobile station 12 only utilizes its digital transceiver 50 (Figure 5) to communicate with the cordless cellular base station 10. However, in other embodiments the mobile station may also be compliant with other communications standards such as such as those standards which are compliant with 1.9 GHz operation, such as provisional standard PN-3388 which is also available from the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA).
Preferably, the mobile station 12 has an initial preference for its last network registration; that is, when the mobile station 12 is powered ON, the mobile station 12 automatically synchronizes to is last operating frequency and attempts to register with the control channel on that frequency. If it fails to locate a control channel on that frequency, the mobile station will scan the other frequencies to locate the best control channel. Most likely, the mobile station will end up registering with the closest regional cellular base station 18 in the cellular network 16. After it has registered with the regional cellular network, as described in more detail below, when the mobile station 12 comes into proximity with a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges, the mobile station 12 automatically deregisters from the regional cellular network 16 and registers with the cordless cellular base station 10. As described briefly above and in more detail below, the mobile station 12 stores information regarding the cellular service in the area surrounding the cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has recently registered. Thus, the mobile station 12 constantly compares the information about the regional cell 18 it is currently in to see if it is a cell that is likely to contain one of the cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has most recently registered. If it is in a regional cell 18 that is likely to contain a cordless cellular base station 10 that it has recently registered with, it attempts to locate that cordless cellular base station 10 utilizing information that it has stored about the operating parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10.
Therefore, the mobile station 12 includes a certain portion of its memory 47 (Figure 5) that is dedicated to the semi-permanent storage of the operating frequency and other information related to one or more cordless cellular base stations 10 with which it has recently registered. Preferably, the mobile station 12 semi-permanently retains, in an EEPROM, a cordless cellular base station storage table 78, as illustrated in Figure 6, which stores information about three cordless cellular base stations with which it has previously registered. While storage for three cordless cellular base stations 10 is currently preferred, it is contemplated that appropriate applications storage for additional cordless cellular base stations 10 is possible. A top row 80 holds data for a "primary" cordless cellular base station. The "primary" cordless cellular base station is, for example, the cordless cellular base station 10 in the user's home or office, which is most often accessed by the user and is responsible for the bills associated with the subscription to this service. The user defines which cordless cellular base station is the "primary" base station. In a preferred embodiment, after the mobile station 12 initially registers with the cordless cellular base station 10, the user enters a specified keystroke procedure, which may advantageously be entering the number 1 key followed by the # key on the mobile station keypad, to allow the user to designate the cordless cellular base station 10 currently in use as the "primary" cordless cellular base station. The second and third rows 82, 84 advantageously hold data for the two most recently used non-primary cordless cellular base stations 10 in the order of most recent use. The mobile station 12 maintains the information for the primary cordless cellular base station at all times in the top row 80. The mobile station 12 manages the ordering of the lower rows, shuffling them as necessary to ensure that the second row 82 has the data for the non-primary cordless cellular base station 10 used most recently, and the third row 84 has the data for the non-primary cordless cellular base station 10 used next most recently.
In the horizontal direction, the table 78 is divided into first and second parts 85, 87. The first part 85 of the table 78 stores information about the cordless cellular base station 10, such as the cordless cellular base station identification number and last known operating channel and back-up channel for the cordless cellular base stations 10. The second part 87 of the table 78 stores information about the cellular service for the regional cell
18 in which the cordless cellular base station 10 exists.
The first part 85 of the table 78 preferably includes the following information regarding the cordless cellular base station 10: a Residential System ID (RSID) 86, the operating channel fn 88, and back up channels f1 ( f2, and f3 90-94 respectively, the country code CC 96 and the system operating code SOC 98. The RSID is a 16-bit serial number that identifies the cordless cellular base station 10. The RSID is assigned to the cordless cellular base station by the cellular network 16 during its initial authorization procedure. The RSID 86 is broadcast by the cordless cellular base station 10 over the digital control channel (DCCH) in accordance with the IS- 136 standard for the mobile station 12 to recognize and to attempt to register with the cordless cellular base station 10. The mobile station 12 restores the RSID in the table 78 after the initial registration with the cordless cellular base station 10 to help the mobile station 12 relocate the cordless cellular base station 10 the next time it comes within range. The channel information is the current or last known operating channel fg 88, and three alternative channels f„ f2, and f3 90-94, respectively, on which the cordless cellular base station 10 may operate. The alternate channels are the channels on which the digital control channel (DCCH) for the cordless cellular base station would most likely be detected. These channels are determined by the cordless cellular base station 10 based on its measurement of the interference environment using a procedure which is described in more detail below. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station 10 broadcasts a neighbor list which includes the alternate channels for cordless cellular base station operation. The neighbor list is then stored by the mobile station. In an alternate embodiment, the alternate channels are supplied to the mobile station 12 by the cordless cellular base station 10 via data or other delivery packets which are periodically transmitted by the cordless cellular base station 10 over the digital control channel (DCCH), while the mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10. The country code CC 96 is the country code for the landline 14 to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected. The System Operator Code SOC 98 is the system operator code for the service provider. In the case of a cellular network, the McCaw network has its individual code, as do other service providers. Together, the country code CC 96, the System Operator Code SOC 98, and the RSID 86, are referred to herein as the "extended RSID" 100. Preferably, when the mobile station 12 is trying to determine if it has located a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered it compares the "extended RSID" 100 it has stored with the broadcast extended RSID from the cordless cellular base station 10. In the preferred embodiment, when the mobile station 12 compares a stored extended RSID 100 against a cordless cellular base station's broadcasted extended RSID for a match, the following rules are used. If the CC 96 of the cordless cellular base station 10 was not previously obtained by the mobile station 12, the mobile station 12 treats this as if the two CCs are known and match. In effect, an unknown CC 96 is treated as a wild card.
Using the extended RSID 100 rather than the RSID 86 by itself provides an additional level of protection against inadvertent registration with a cordless cellular base station 10 in the wrong area which happen to have the same RSID as the mobile station 12 has stored. For example, you do not want your mobile station 12 to try to register with a cordless cellular base station 10 of a person in Canada which may have the same RSID 86 as a cordless cellular base station 10 in the United States. By using the extended RSID 100 thus checking the country code CC 96, the system operating code SOC 98 and the RSID 100, such errors are obviated.
The second part 87 of the table 78 includes the following information regarding the regional cell 18 in which the cordless cellular base station 10 exists: a system identifier SID 102 of the cell, a plurality of public service profiles PSP„, PSP„ PSP2, and PSP3 104-110 which further characterize the cell 18. The System Identifier SID 102 is an identification number for a metropolitan area within the cellular network 16 within which the cordless cellular base station 10 is located. Each metropolitan area in the regional cellular network 16 is assigned its own SID 102. The mobile station 12 uses the SID to identify when the mobile station 12 is in an area which is most likely to contain a known cordless cellular base station 10. There may be several cells 18 which operate within the metropolitan area. Thus, it is advantageous to use some further available information to help uniquely identify the cells within which a desired cordless cellular base station is located. The Public Service Profile preferably contains, in the case of a digital regional cell, the digital control channel (DCCH) channel number for the regional cell and the 8-bit Digital Verification Color Code (DVCC) number for the regional cell in which the cordless cellular base station was last located. The DVCC is sent by the base station to the mobile station and is coded to form the Coded Digital Verification Color Code (CDVCC). The DVCC is a 12-bit data field which contains the 8-bit DVCC and 4 protection bits generated by the base station. The CDVCC is sent in each time slot to and from the mobile stations and base station. The CDVCC is used to indicate that the correct data to/from the base station from/to the mobile station is being decoded. These numbers are well known to those in the art. In the case of an analog regional cell, the Public Service Profile preferably contains the Analog Control Channel number (ACCH) for the regional cell and the Digital Color Code (DCC) number for the regional cell within which the cordless cellular base station 10 was last located. The DCC is a digital signal transmitted by a base station on a forward analog control channel that is used to detect capture of the appropriate base station by a particular mobile station. These numbers are well known to those of skill in the art. The purpose for storing the Public Service Profile is to have additional information about the regional cellular service in which the desired cordless cellular base station 10 is located, so that it is more likely the correct regional cells will be identified corresponding to the cordless cellular base station.
The mobile station 12 is responsible for populating the PSP columns 104-110 of the table 78. In order to be able to do this, in a preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 receives the broadcast neighbor list from the cordless cellular base station 10 and infers the PSPs from the neighbor list. The neighbor list message which is typically broadcast by a base station is specified by the IS-136 standard and includes the ability to designate certain channels as preferred channels, certain channels as non-preferred channels and certain channels as regular channels. A channel designated as a preferred channel would cause the receiving mobile station to switch its operating channel over to this preferred channel. The non-preferred and regular channels do not require such immediate action from the mobile station. The cordless cellular base station takes advantage of this predefined IS- 136 broadcast neighbor list message, but instead of sending information regarding the make up of nearby peer cells over the neighbor list message, the cordless cellular base station sends PSP information regarding the cells which overlap the CCBS coverage area and information regarding the backup channels that the CCBS may choose to switch to. In addition, the cordless cellular base station may include additional channels which are not backup channels but are channels that the CCBS wants the mobile station to be aware of. Up to four PSPs are sent over the broadcast neighbor list and are designated as non-preferred channels. The remainder of the neighbor list is made up of the backup channels and other channels which are all indicated as regular channels. When the mobile station 12 receives the neighbor list from the cordless cellular base station 10, it extracts the PSP information for those channels which are indicated as non-preferred channels and stores this information in the cordless cellular base station storage table 78.
The CCBS determines the channels which are to be included in the neighbor list message as the non- preferred channels by determining the public cells that the CCBS is within or nearby by using the following procedure. The CCBS scans all of the channels in the cellular spectrum and performing received signal strength (RSS) measurements on each channel. It will look at the activity on the channel having the highest RSS measurements to see if the activity on the channel is due to a public digital control channel. If the signal is not due to a public digital control channel, the CCBS will switch move to the channel with the next highest RSS measurement, etc. until a 20 dB threshold is reached. If the signal is due to a public digital control channel, the CCBS will store this channel as an active digital control channel for a public cell whose coverage area includes or is near that CCBS is within or nearby. The CCBS will collect the PSP information for up to four active digital control channels for public cells that the CCBS is within or nearby and will send this information in the broadcast neighbor list message.
In an alternate embodiment, the mobile station 12 collects the Public Service Profile for the regional cell 18 whenever the mobile station enters a new cell 18. During registration with the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 compares the current and previous collected public service profiles (PSPs) with the previously stored public service profiles and updates the table 78 if one or both of these public service profiles is not already present in table 78. The reason that the public service profile may change is that it is possible that a cordless cellular base station 10 may be located in a place over which the regional ceil which provides service may change, i.e., the cordless cellular base station may be at a location where the service range of up to four adjacent cells overlap. By storing up to four public service profiles, no matter which cell is servicing the mobile station 12 as it approaches the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 will still recognize that it needs to try to locate the cordless cellular base station 10. The most recently collected public service profile is always stored as PSP0. When the public service profile changes, the public service profile that was previously stored as PSP0 is stored as PSP,, and the public service profile which was stored as PSP, is stored as PSP2, etc. The term "extended Public Service Profile" 112 is used herein to mean the combination of the SID 102 and a PSP. The mobile station 12 verifies that the current SID matches the SID of the regional cell 18 containing the cordless cellular base station 10 before checking the PSP. Once a SID match is found the PSPs are checked in order for a match. The extended PSP 112 must match before the mobile station 12 begins looking for a specific cordless cellular base station 10. For example, the mobile station 12 checks the SID of the cell that it is presently in and compares it to SIDs for each of the cordless cellular base stations 10 that the mobile station 12 is registered with to determine if the mobile station 12 is in a SID that is likely to have a known cordless cellular base station 10. In this way, the mobile station 12 does not look for a specific cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 is roaming in some distant city with an unfamiliar SID. Further, the use of the SID reduces the chance that the mobile station 12 will erroneously attempt to register with a cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 user is in another city or state. To further reduce this risk, in a preferred embodiment, the extended PSP also contains the country code, CC, for the country in which the cordless cellular base station resides which prevents the mobile station from searching for the cordless cellular base station when the SID matches but the mobile station is in the wrong country.
Features of the Cordless Cellular Base Station Initial Authorization of the Cordless Cellular Base Station In order to maintain a secure system, the cordless cellular base station 10 first initially registers with the cellular network 16 in order to authorize its use. In fact, the cordless cellular base station 10 is not operational without the network authorization, as the cellular network 16 provides the cordless cellular base station 10 with certain operational parameters, such as the authorized operating frequency list for its operation.
Preferably, when a customer purchases a cordless cellular base station 10, the seller will contact the cellular network 16 and provide it with certain information about the cordless cellular base station 10, such as the electronic serial number of the cordless cellular base station 10, the landline number to which the user plans to hook¬ up the cordless cellular base station 10, etc. In addition, it is expected that the seller will also provide the mobile identification number (MIN) of the primary user's mobile station 12 to the cellular network for subscription to the call forwarding feature. Once the cordless cellular base station 10 is brought to the location where the cordless cellular base station
10 will reside, the user connects the cordless cellular base station 10 to a telephone jack 58 associated with the user's landline 14 and a power source (not shown), such as a typical wall socket. In a preferred embodiment, the user depresses a network authorization function key 62 on the cordless cellular base station 10. In one alternate embodiment, once the power source is connected to the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically initializes a cellular network authorization procedure. Alternatively, the system could advantageously accept a series of specified numbers and symbols on the telephone keypad (Figure 3), such as 4648#, as instructions to manually initialize the network authorization procedure.
As illustrated in Figure 7, the network authorization procedure for a new cordless cellular base station 10 is described. After the automatic network authorization procedure has been initialized or the manual keystroke commands have been depressed, the processor 46 uses the standard telephone interface hardware 29 on the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 to initiate a call to a preset cellular network authorization phone number, such as a remote network update number, via the landline 14 in a step 64. Preferably, the cellular network authorization number is stored in semi-permanent memory in the cordless cellular base station 10.
After the cellular network (CN) 16 answers the call from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 initiates a modem link in modem setup step 66 with the cordless cellular base station 10 on the landline 14. This modem link can be established using the AT&T 800 Transaction Access Service Option or may be provided by a separate modem pool. The cordless cellular base station 10 makes at least two attempts to set up a modem link with the network 16. The modem 27 of the cordless cellular base station 10 and a modem 27 in the cellular network 16 are synchronized, and a modem link is established. At least two attempts are made to establish the modem link. Once the modem link is established, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization request message in step 68. The authorization request message includes the electronic serial number of the cordless cellular base station for identification purposes. The network verifies that the cordless cellular base station 10 which is identified by the electronic serial number is calling from the landline number which was given to the cellular network when the cordless cellular base station was purchased. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station uses the (CNI) calling number identification feature of the telephone line from the PSTN 15 to verify that the call that is being received is, in fact, on the landline 14 that was stored in the regional cellular system. If the landline number on which the modem link is established is the same as the stored landline number, the cellular network 16 accepts an initial authentication message (AUTH) from the cordless cellular base station 10 and sends an initial authorization message (auth) to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 72. The cellular network 16 downloads certain operational parameters for the cordless cellular base station 10 in the authorization message. In the preferred embodiment the authorization message comprises (a) Primary MIN; (b) CCBS-ID - Password to be used by the CCBS in subsequent communication with the CCBS VLR; (c) Public SID (SID) - the System Identification in which this CCBS should be operating; (d) Residential SID (RSID) - the Residential System Identification which should identify this CCBS; (e) CCBS_Auth_Count - the initial value to use for fraud protection; (f) Registration/Deregistration Flag - an indication to the CCBS which registrations and deregistrations for which the CCBS VLR would like to be informed; (g) Authorization Frequencies - a list of frequencies within which the cellular base station is authorized to operate; (h) Remote Network Update Number 1 (RNUN1) - the number which the CCBS should use for further communication with the CCBS; (i) Remote Network Update Number 2 (RNUN2) - the alternate number which the CCBS should use if the Remote Network Update Number 1 no longer works; (j) LLN - the land line number on which this CCBS should be operating, (k) SOC - the system operator code for the cellular provider; (I) Authorization Power - the authorized operating power level; ( ) Transmitted Signal Strength - the maximum signal strength for which this CCBS should operate; and (n) Receive Signal Strength - the minimum signal strength for which this CCBS will consider a mobile set channel. The operating frequencies are, in a preferred embodiment, a portion of the frequencies in the cellular spectrum. However, the operating frequencies may include all of the frequencies in the cellular spectrum. The authorization power level is the power level at which the CCBS is authorized to operate. In one embodiment, the user has the option of the level of service that he or she wants to receive and could be changed a different fee for a different level of service. For example, the user could choose either a lesser area of coverage for the CCBS, a normal area of coverage for the CCBS or an expanded area of coverage for the CCBS wherein each of these coverage areas would have a corresponding authorization or authorized power level. Depending upon the level of service requested by the user, the corresponding authorized power level will be sent to the CCBS in the authorization message. The parameters received during the authorization step (auth) are stored in the memory of the cordless cellular base station 10 and are used for operation. Preferably, the parameters are stored in an EEPROM. The cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of the auth message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 74. Once the return result message is received and the initialization procedure is complete, either the cordless cellular base station 10 or the cellular network 16 releases the call (Release call) in step 76. If any of the above attempts to initialize the cordless cellular base station 10 fail, the initialization procedure is canceled by the cellular network 16 and, the authorization step is reattempted after a certain period of time. If the second attempt fails, the user can recontact the cellular network 16 by placing another call on the landline 14 to the cellular network 16 to request that the initialization procedure be tried over again.
After the network authorization is complete, the cellular network 16 retains a permanent record of the cordless cellular base station's unique identification password number, the mobile station ID number of the primary mobile station 12 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 and the landline number that is associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. In one embodiment, once the cordless cellular base station 10 has completed a successful network authorization procedure with the cellular network 16, an indicator on the cordless cellular base station 10 is illuminated to signify that the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for use.
In an alternate embodiment, the network authorization procedure is similar to that described above, except that the user initiates the authorization procedure by calling the cellular network authorization phone number on the user's standard telephone landline 14 and providing the cellular network 16 with the landline number (LLN) to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected. The cellular network (CN) 16 initiates the telephone call (Initial Call) to the landline number on the public switched telephone network (PSTN) 15 to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected. The user does not answer the telephone call; instead, the landline communications hardware 29 (Figure 3) on the cordless cellular base station 10 is allowed to answer the call. After a telephone link between the cordless cellular base station 10 and the cellular network 16 has been established, the authorization procedure proceeds as described above, by setting up a modem link and following the flow outline in Figure 7. Cordless Cellular Base Station Registration List
As the number of cordless cellular base station users increase it will become more and more likely that cordless cellular base stations 10 will be present in adjoining houses. In such cases, it is not desirable to enable automatic registration for all mobile stations 12 that come into proximity with a cordless cellular base station 10. Advantageously, the preferred registration scheme allows the cordless cellular base station 10 to be accessible only to users who have been previously been granted the registration privilege. The cordless cellular base station 10 maintains a cordless cellular base station registration list 113 in a semipermanent portion of the memory 21 (Figure 3) which stores the mobile system identification number of the mobile stations 12 which have been previously been granted registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10. By requiring preregistratioπ of mobile stations 12, before automatic registration occurs, accidental automatic registration with a nearby cordless cellular base station 10 is prevented, however the convenience of automatic registration for frequent users is still available. As illustrated in Figure 8, the cordless cellular base station registration list 113 is preferably broken down into first and second parts 114, 115. The mobile station identification numbers MINS of the "primary" mobile stations 12 which are granted automatic registration privileges with the cordless cellular base station 10 are stored in the first part 114 of the list 113. The primary users are the owners of the cordless cellular base station 10 and are normally the users who are billed for the services of the cordless cellular base station 10. The mobile station identification numbers MIN of the "non-primary" mobile stations 12 most recently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 are stored in the second part 115 of the list 113. In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 is advantageously capable of granting automatic registration privileges to a limited number of mobile stations 12 whose MINs are stored in the cordless cellular base station registration list 113. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station 10 is capable of granting registration privileges to two primary users and eight non-primary users. However, depending upon the preferred use, the numbers could be less than or greater than those indicated above. The primary users in the first part 114 of the list are preferably not changeable without intervention by an authorized agent or by communication with the regional cellular network 16. The second part 115 of the list
113 listing the non-primary mobile stations most recently granted automatic registration privileges is advantageously maintained in order of most recent registration to the cordless cellular base station 12. Thus, if the second part 115 of the list 113 is already full, the last non-primary mobile station on the list, i.e., the mobile station least recently granted automatic registration, is deleted from the list 113 and a new mobile station is granted automatic registration privileges and is placed at the top of the second part 114 or non-primary registration list.
The cordless cellular base station 10 may also advantageously provide an LCD display of the second part
114 of the list 113 listing the non-primary mobile stations 12 most recently granted automatic registration privileges. In this embodiment, the user depresses a function key on the cordless cellular base station to display the second part 114 of the list 113 listing the non-primary mobile stations. Once the second part 114 of the list 113 is displayed, the user scrolls through the list of displayed mobile station identification numbers to select a number that he would like to delete. The user then depresses a function key labeled delete on the cordless cellular base station 10 or in an alternative embodiment can enter a series of keys such as, 335#, on the keypad of the cordless cellular base station 10 to delete the highlighted numbers from the second part 115 of the automatic registration list 113. For each entry, the cordless cellular base station registration list 113 stores a status record 116 that indicates the state of the mobile station with respect to the cordless cellular base station and a mobile station identification number record 117. Preferably, there are three states of a mobile station 12 with respect to the cordless cellular base station 10 which are referred to as the : "standby", "active" and "dormant" states. The dormant state, shown by a "D" on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12, which has previously registered with the cordless cellular base station 10, is not currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10. The standby state, which is indicated by a "S" on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12 is currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is not currently on a call, i.e., the mobile station 12 is "standing by" waiting to receive or place a call through the cordless cellular base station 10. The active state, which is shown by an "A" on the table 113, indicates that the mobile station 12 is registered with the cordless cellular base station 10 and is currently on a call which is being controlled by the cordless cellular base station 10. As indicate above, in the preferred embodiment, up to two mobile stations 12 may be listed as active at a time. Initial Registration
When a user wants to use a mobile station 12 which was not previously registered with the cordless cellular base station 10, the following initial registration procedure is performed described as follows with reference to Figures 9 and 10. Figure 9 shows the messages which are passed between the mobile station 12 and the cordless cellular base station 10. Figure 10 shows the process which takes place in the cordless cellular base station 10 to enable the initial registration. In step 119 of Figure 9, the user presses the initial registration button 111 (Figure 2) on the cordless cellular base station 10. In the flow chart of Figure 10, at action block 120 the depression of the initial registration button is detected and control passes to action block 121. At action block 121, the cordless cellular base station 10 sets a new registration (new-reg) timer. Preferably, the new registration timer is set for 30 seconds.
After the initial registration button 111 on the cordless cellular base station 10 is depressed, the user of the mobile station 12 activates a test registration procedure on the mobile station in step 109. In a preferred embodiment, the test registration procedure is activated by the user depressing a test registration function key on the mobile station 12. In an alternate embodiment, the user may depress a series of specified keys on the mobile station keypad, such as 878#, to initiate the test registration procedure on the mobile station 12. The initiation of the test registration function causes the mobile station 12 to measure the received signal strength on each channel and to store the measurement. The mobile station then checks the channels which have the strongest receive signal strength to determine if a digital control channel (DCCH) is present. If a DCCH is not present, the mobile station checks the channel with the next highest receive signal strength. If a DCCH is present, the mobile station checks to see if its system ID identifies it as a private system. If it is a private system, the mobile station tries to register with the device by sending out a test registration message (TR) in step 122 of Figure 9. The test registration message is specified by the IS- 136 standard.
At decision block 123 of Figure 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the test registration message is received from a mobile station 12. If the test registration message is received, control passes to decision block 124. If the test registration message is not received control passes to decision block 125, where the cordless cellular base station checks to see if the new registration timer (new-reg) has expired. If the timer has not expired, control returns to decision block 123. If the timer has expired, the initial registration attempt is completed.
At decision block 124, the cordless cellular base station 10 determines if the registration list of Figure 8 is full. If there is still room in the registration list, control passes to action block 126. If the registration list is full, control passes to decision block 127. At decision block 127, the cordless cellular base station 10 determines if the status of one of the non-primary mobile stations 12 in the registration list is indicated as being dormant. If the status of one of the non-primary mobile stations 12 is indicated as being dormant, control passes to action block 128. If none of the non-primary mobile stations 12 is listed as being dormant, control passes to action block 129. At action block 129, a negative test registration response is sent to the mobile station and the initial registration process is abandoned. At action block 128, the non-primary mobile station 12 with the longest inactivity time is removed from the registration list and control passes to action block 126. In the preferred embodiment, the non- primary mobile station with the longest inactivity time would be the last non-primary mobile station on the registration list.
At action block 126, the mobile station identification number of the requesting mobile station is added to the registration list. Next, at action block 130, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a positive test registration response message (TRR) to the mobile station 12 and control passes to decision block 133.
The transmission of the positive or negative test registration response from the cordless cellular base station to the mobile station is shown in step 131 of Figure 9. If a negative test registration response, or no test registration response is received at the mobile station, the mobile station will check the channel with the next highest receive signal strength and repeat the procedure indicated above to try to determine if it is a private system, and if so, to try to register with the device by sending out a test registration message (TR).
Upon receiving the positive test registration response, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, the mobile station 12 will display a set of alpha characters transmitted by the cordless cellular base station 10 in the test registration message. In the preferred embodiment, the alpha characters which are displayed form the word "cordless", at which time the mobile station may decide to accept or reject the cordless registration with the cordless cellular base station. If the user wishes to accept the registration, he depresses a specified series of keys on the keypad, such as 9#. If the user accepts the registration, the mobile station sends a registration message (R) in step 132 of Figure 9 to the cordless cellular base station. If the user wishes to reject the registration, the user depresses another specified series of keys on the keypad, such as 6# or in another embodiment does not depress any keys. If the registration is rejected, no message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10.
In the meantime, at decision block 133, the cordless cellular base 10 checks to see if a registration message has been received from the mobile station. If a registration message (R) is received, control passes to action block 134. If a registration message (R) was not received control passes to decision block 135 where the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the new_reg timer has expired. If the new_reg timer has not expired, control returns to decision block 133 where the cordless cellular base station will continue to check for the receipt of the registration message (R) from the mobile station. If the new_reg timer has expired without the cordless cellular base station 10 receiving a response from the mobile station 12, control passes to action block 136 where the initial registration attempt is canceled.
At action block 134, the new_reg timer is stopped and control passes to action block 137. At action block 137, the cordless cellular base station sends a registration accept message (RA) to the mobile station as is shown in step 138 of Figure 9 and control passes to action block 139. At action block 139, the status of the mobile station 12 is updated as being in standby mode and the initial registration procedure is completed. At action block 140, the cordless cellular base station 10 proceeds with the network update attempt procedure as described in association with Figure 13 below.
After the mobile station 12 has completed the initial registration with the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station 12 will automatically register with the cordless cellular base station 10 without the need to go through the initial registration procedure. Thus, when a mobile station 12 comes within range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges and the mobile station 12 is not currently handling a call, in accordance with the preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 automatically switches from regional cellular service mode to cordless telephone landline service mode without user intervention. The automatic registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10 is discussed in more detail below. Automatic Registration of a Mobile Station with a Cordless Cellular Base Station
The mobile station 12 only attempts to locate a cordless cellular base station 10 when the mobile station 12 is not currently handling a call. When a mobile station 12 that is not currently handling a call comes into the range of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has been granted automatic registration privileges, the mobile station 12 preferably automatically deregisters from the cellular network and registers with the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 advantageously is able to communicate with up to two mobile stations 12 at one time. The cordless cellular base station 10 displays an indication of whether its digital control channel (DCCH) is supporting one or more mobile stations 12. In a preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 displays the mobile identification number of each mobile station 12 that the cordless cellular base station's digital control channel (DCCH) is currently supporting. The cordless cellular base station 10 remains ready to receive registrations and other legitimate requests from the mobile stations 12 at any time.
In general, the range in which automatic registration with the cordless cellular base station 10 is achievable is dictated by the strength of the transmission signal from the cordless cellular base station 10. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station 10 is capable of transmitting an approximately 6.3 W signal. This translates into an automatic registration range for the cordless cellular base station 10 of approximately 500-1,000 feet. The variation in the registration range is due to the values broadcast on the DCCH of the cordless cellular base station, variations in weather conditions, surrounding EMI interference, and sizes and layouts of the buildings in which the cordless cellular base station 10 may be located. Location of the Cordless Cellular Base Station bv a Mobile Station
As illustrated in Figure 10, when the mobile station 12 is being served by a control channel and is not currently handling a call, the mobile station 12 searches for the presence of the cordless cellular base station 10 after each selection of a new control channel. Once a new channel is selected, at decision block 140 the cordless cellular base station checks to see if a new digital control channel is selected. If at decision block 140, a new digital control channel is acquired, control passes to action block 142. If at decision block 140, a new digital control channel is not acquired, control passes to decision block 141. If at decision block 141 a new analog control channel is acquired, control passes to action block 142. If at action block 141 a new analog control channel is not acquired, control retums to decision block 140.
At action block 142, the current extended Public Service Profile of the mobile station 12 is compared to all the stored extended Public Service Profiles in the table 78 (Figure 6) in the mobile station for each of cordless cellular base stations 10 that are stored. For an analog control channel, the extended public service profile preferably contains the CC, SID, ACCH channel number and DCC for the control channel as described above. For a digital control channel, the extended Public Service Profile preferably contains the CC, SID, DCCH channel number, and DVCC as described above. If at decision block 144 there is an extended PSP match, control passes to action block 146. If at decision block 144, there is no extended PSP match, control passes to action block 148. At action block 146 once an extended PSP match is made, it is possible that the mobile station 12 is within the vicinity of a cordless cellular base station 10 with which it has previously registered. As known to those of skill in the art, the mobile station 12 is provided with a list of frequencies by the cellular network 16 called a neighbor list (NL). As known to those of skill in the art, the neighbor list is a list of frequencies that the neighboring cells operate on and assists the mobile station in selecting nearby cells for control when the signal strength of the current cell is no longer optimal. In a typical mobile station 12, the mobile station scans the channels on the neighbor list to determine if a control channel which is stronger than its current control channel can be located on the channels of the neighboring cells. Once a clearer channel is located, the mobile station automatically "camps onto" the new control channel. Thus at action block 146 when an extended PSP match is made, the mobile station 12 advantageously adds the stored primary and alternate cordless cellular base station frequencies that the digital control channel (DCCH) of the cordless cellular base station 10 was detected on, i.e., fg, fj, f2, f3, for each row in the table 78 (Figure 6) on which an extended PSP match was found, to the Neighbor List (NL) forming an extended neighbor list (ENL). Thus, at action block 148, each of the frequencies of the neighbor list are sequentially scanned to determine if a clearer control channel can be located. If on one of the frequencies of the neighbor list that the mobile station is scanning, a private system identifier, such as the RSID of the cordless cellular base station, is detected, in accordance with the IS-136 standard, the mobile station 12 synchronizes with that control channel and checks to see if this is an identifier that the mobile station recognizes. At decision block 150, the mobile station compares the identifier that is obtained for the control channel with the extended RSID for the cordless cellular base station that it is scanning for. As described above, an extended RSID is preferably a country code (CC), a System Operator Code (SOC), and a 16-bit Residential System ID (RSID) for the cordless cellular base station 10. If an extended RSID match is detected, control passes to action block 154. If an extended RSID match is not detected, control passes to action block 152 where the mobile station checks to see if the signal strength of any of the frequencies on the neighbor list is strong enough to warrant a channel change. If at decision block 148 the signal strength of one of the channels is strong enough to select a new channel, control returns to decision block 140. If at decision block 152 none of the channels are strong enough to warrant a channel change, control returns to action block 148 where the channels on the neighbor list are continually scanned. At action block 154, the mobile station deregisters from the regional cellular network. Control passes to action block 156 where the mobile station attempts to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 using the CCBS registration procedure described below in association with Figure 12. If registration succeeds, the mobile station camps on the cordless cellular base station's Digital Control Channel (DCCH). Automatic Registration of a Cordless Cellular Base Station (CCBS)
When the mobile station 12 has determined that it is in proximity with the cordless cellular base station 10 using the procedures described above, the mobile station 12 attempts to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 using the procedure illustrated in Figure 12. Initially, at decision block 158 the cordless cellular base station 10 checks to see if the mobile station identification number (MIN) of the mobile station 12 matches a MIN stored in the automatic registration list in the cordless cellular base station 10. If the MIN of the mobile station matches one of the stored MINs, control passes to action block 160. If the MIN of the mobile station 12 does not match one of the stored MINs, control passes to action block 162. At action block 162, the automatic registration attempt is rejected and control passes to action block 164 where the automatic CCBS registration procedure is terminated. At action block 160, the automatic registration attempt of the mobile station 12 is accepted. Next, at decision block 166, the cordless cellular base station 10 checks the status of the mobile station in the registration list of Figure 8. If the mobile station 12 is listed as dormant, i.e., not in active or standby modes, control passes to action block 172. If the mobile station 12 is not listed as dormant, control passes to action block 168. At action block 168, the automatic CCBS registration procedure is considered to be completed and control passes to action block 170 where the automatic CCBS registration procedure is terminated.
At action block 172, the status of the mobile station 12 is updated as being in standby mode. At action block 174, the automatic CCBS registration procedure is considered to be completed and control passes to action block 176. At action block 176, the cordless cellular base station 10 proceeds with the network update attempt procedure as described in association with Figure 13 below. Network Update Attempt
Figure 13 illustrates the network update attempt procedure that the cordless cellular base station uses to contact the cellular network to inform it of a recent mobile station registration. At decision block 190, the state of the landline 14 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 is checked to determine if the network call forwarding procedure can be initialized. If at decision block 190, the state of the landline 14 is idle, control passes to action block 192, where the Network Call Forwarding Procedure as described in association with Figures 14a and 14b is initiated. If at decision block 190, the state of the landline 14 is not idle, control passes to decision block 194. At decision block 194, the state of the landline is checked to determine if it is busy. If the landline 14 is busy, control passes to decision block 195. If the land line is not busy control passed to decision block 196. At decision block 196, the state of the land line is checked to determine if the landline is ringing. If the land line is not ringing, control passes to action block 195. If the land line is ringing, control passes to decision block 198. At decision block 198, the state of the voice channels for the first and second mobile stations of the cordless cellular base station are checked to see if there is room to add the mobile station onto the ringing call. If both channels are busy, for example, an intercom call between two mobile stations is in progress, control passes to action block 195. If both channels are not busy, control passes to action block 200. At action block 200, the newly added mobile station is paged, in a manner known to those of skill in the art, and can be added on to the present ringing call if the user presses the send key on the mobile station 12. Whether the mobile responds or not, control passes to action block 195.
At action block 195, the Network Call Forwarding Procedure is queued until the cordless cellular base station and the landline are both free and are able to initiate the network call forwarding procedure. The network call forwarding procedure is described below in association with Figures 14a and 14b. Post-Mobile Station Registration
After the mobile station 12 is registered and referring back to Figure 6, for a new non-primary cordless cellular base station, for a cordless cellular base station that was not previously on the list, the mobile station 12 places the data for this cordless cellular base station 10 in the most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station row 84, just below the row for the primary cordless cellular base station 82. The data for the previous most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station is moved to the next most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station row 86. The row for the least recently used non-primary cordless cellular base station, i.e., the previous next most recent cordless cellular base station row, may be lost. For the most recent non-primary cordless cellular base station row 84, the mobile station 12 places the data regarding the cellular network that it just deregistered from into the table 78. If the cordless cellular base station was already included on the list, the new information simply replaces the information in the old row. The mobile station 12 places the current Country Code in the CC cell, the current System Operator Code in the SOC cell, and the current System Identifier in the SID cell the most recent row as collected from the cordless cellular base station. In addition, the public service profile for the mobile station is inferred from the broadcast neighbor list that is received from the cordless cellular base station 10 as described above. When the mobile station 12 has registered with the cordless cellular base station 10, the mobile station
12 functions as a cordless telephone mobile station, referred to as operating in the cordless telephone landline service mode. In the cordless mode, the mobile station provides basic and enhanced telephone services over the landline connected to the cordless cellular base station 10. The mobile station supports the enhanced telephone services that are provided by the land network services when it operates in cordless mode, such as call waiting, three-way calling, party line service (i.e., enabling multiple landline numbers to access a single landline), and distinctive ringing services (i.e., different ringing patterns based on the incoming calling number). Network Call Forwarding
After a successful registration of the mobile station 12 with the cordless cellular base station 10, in a preferred embodiment the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a call forwarding update message to the cellular network 16 requesting that the cellular network 16 route all calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. As indicated above, the CCBS VLR informs the cordless cellular base station during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities the CCBS VLR would like to be informed. For example, some of the types of registrations/deregistrations that the CCBS VLR may want to be informed of include: power down registration, power up registration, location area, forced registration, periodic registration, deregistration, new system registration, ACC to DCCH, or TMSI timeout. In the case when the CCBS VLR wants to be informed of a location area registration, the location update or call forwarding procedure as illustrated in Figure 14a is executed. The cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 dials the stored remote network update number via the PSTN 15 (the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 tries the Remote Network Update Number 1 first and if it is busy it tries the Remote Network Update Number 2) in a network contact calling step 202 (Network Contact Update Call) to contact the cellular network (CN) 16. The cellular network 16 upon answering the call sets up a modem link in step 206. In an authentication step (AUTH) 208, the cordless cellular base station 10 starts an authorization timer and sends an authentication message to the cellular network 16 which includes the mobile system identification number to be updated, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count. The cordless cellular base station authorization count maintains a running count of the number of updates the cordless cellular base station 10 has made over this landline number as a fraud prevention mechanism. The cellular network 16 compares the call number ID (CNI) from the PSTN 15 for the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 which made the call with the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 stored in a data base on the cellular network 16 and verifies that the mobile system identification number to be updated, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count provided by the cordless cellular base station 10 match the stored values in the cellular network 16. Once the authentication message is processed and validated, a return result message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 210 and the cordless cellular base station authorization count is updated. Further, the cellular network sets a message receive timer to see if the cordless cellular base station 10 is going to send it a message in a specified time period. If the authentication message can not be validated, i.e., if any of the above-referenced values do not match, the cellular network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
In the meantime, the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the authentication timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt a new connection with the cellular network 16 after a specified period of time has elapsed.
After receiving the return result message, the cordless cellular base station 10 stops the authentication timer, starts a location update timer and sends a location update message to the cellular network 16 in step 212 via a modem link. In a preferred embodiment, the location update message comprises the mobile station identification number (MIN) of the registered mobile station 12 for which the calls are to be forwarded and the landline number to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected. The cellular network 16 receives the location update information from the cordless cellular base station 10, verifies that it agrees with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, and stops the message receive timer. If the parameters received from the cordless cellular base station 10 do not agree with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, the cellular network 16 sends an error message to the cordless cellular base station 10 and resets the message receive timer. If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 resends the return result message, resets the message receive timer one more time, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the parameters received from the cordless cellular base station 10 agree with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, the cellular network 16 updates the information stored in the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) regarding the mobile station location and sends a return result message in step 214 to the cordless cellular base station 10 over the modem link to verify the receipt of the information.
In the meantime, the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the location update timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt to resend the location update message after a specified period of time has passed. Once the return result message has been received by the cordless cellular base station 10, the location update timer is stopped. The cellular network 16 ends the call forwarding update procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 220.
Figure 14b illustrates an alternate embodiment of the call forwarding procedure, which is the same as the procedure in Figure 14a from steps 202-212. After the location update message is received, the information in the message has been compared with the stored parameters and matches, and the network updates the information regarding the location of the mobile station, the cellular network checks to see if it needs to send an updated authorization message to the cordless cellular base station 10. If the cellular network needs to send an authorization message, instead of sending the return result message 214 as in Figure 14a, the cellular network 16 sends the cordless cellular base station authorization message which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a list of authorized or operational parameters including operational frequencies, which is the same as the initial authorization message described above, and sets a retum result timer.
If the location update timer expires and no message have been received from the cellular network 16, cordless cellular base station 10 resends the location update message, resets the timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message have been received from the cellular network 16, the cordless cellular base station 10, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If an invalid authorization message is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization error message to the cellular network, resets the timer and may wait for the receipt of a new authorization message.
If a valid authorization message is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 216 over the modem link, the cordless cellular base station 10 updates its operational parameters as received in the message and stops the authorization timer. The cellular network 16 is able to prevent the cordless cellular base station 10 from operating by removing all of its operational frequencies in the cordless cellular base station authorization message. This is a simple way to cancel the service of an unauthorized user. In addition, the network 16 may update the operational parameters, of the cordless cellular base station 10 with the cordless cellular base station authorization message. For example, the cellular network 16 may update the list of operational frequencies of the cordless cellular base station 10, if it is determined that an insufficient number of ciear frequencies have been provided to the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of the authorization message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 218. If the cellular network does not receive the retum result message before its return result timer expires, the cellular network 1 resends the CCBS authorization message, resets the return result timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts a retum result has not been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding update, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the return result message is received, the cellular network 16 ends the call forwarding update procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 220.
After the call forwarding update process is complete, the cellular network 16 routes ali calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
As illustrated in Figure 15, the cellular network 16 can be broken down into the following components: the mobile switching complex (MSC) 222, the home location register (HLR) 224, a traditional visitor location register (VLR) 226 and the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) 228. The mobile switching complex 222, home location register 224 and visitor location register 226 are generally the same as the components that generally exist currently in a standard cellular network, as known to those of skill in the art. The present invention adds the CCBS VLR 228 which is a data base that stores the location, i.e., landline number, of the mobile stations which are being controlled by the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10.
When the cordless cellular base station 10 calls the cellular network 16 in step 230, it is communicating with the CCBS VLR 228 to provide the information regarding the location update and location update cancel requests. When the location update request is received by the CCBS VLR 228, the CCBS VLR 228 sends a REG NOT INVOKE message in step 232 to the HLR 224 associated with the mobile station to inform the HLR 224 that the information for routing calls for that particular mobile station identification number is available from the sending CCBS VLR 228. The HLR 224 responds in step 234 with a REG NOT RETURN RESULT message indicating that it has received and accepted the location update message.
When a call is originated by dialing the mobile station identification on the PSTN 15, the call is sent to the MSC 222 in step 236. The originating MSC 222 sends a LOCATION REQUEST message to the mobile station's HLR 224 in step 238. The HLR 224 recognizes that the location of the mobile station is being controlled by the CCBS VLR 228 which contacted it earlier. In step 240, the HLR 224 constructs a ROUTING REQUEST message and sends it to the CCBS VLR 228 that provided the earlier REG NOT INVOKE message providing an update of the mobile's location. THE CCBS VLR 228 locates a TLDN for the landline that the cordless cellular base station is connected to and returns this information to the HLR 224 in a ROUTING REQUEST RESPONSE message in step 242. The HLR 224 adds the MIN and the ESN of the mobile station to the routing information and retums a LOCATION RESPONSE message to the originating MSC 222 in step 244. The MSC 222 places the call over the PSTN 15 and the call is delivered to the landline number for the cordless cellular base station 10 that is routing the calls for the mobile station. The cordless cellular base station 10 pages the mobile stations 12 listed in standby mode as indicated below and the PSTN 15 rings the extension phones attached to the landline number in step 246, thus completing the call forwarding process. If there are two or fewer mobile stations listed in standby mode, the cordless cellular base station pages the mobile station in a conventional manner as a regional cell would page a mobile station, i.e., providing the digital control channel information and the calling number information to enable the mobile station to answer the call if the send button is depressed. If more than two mobile stations are listed in standby mode, all of the mobile stations receive an alert message which enables the phones to ring, but does not include the digital traffic channel information to answer the call. In this case, the cordless cellular base station listens for the first mobile station to depress the send button. The cordless cellular base station will send that mobile station the digital traffic channel information which will enable the mobile station to answer the call. In another embodiment, if the primary user is listed as being in standby mode, the primary user will always be paged with the digital control channel information to answer the call and the remaining mobiles listed as being in standby will be sent the alert message and will ring. If the primary user presses the send button first, the call will be answered immediately. If one of the other mobile stations presses the send button first, the primary user will be unable to answer the call immediately. The cordless cellular base station will send the first responding mobile station the digital traffic channel information. Upon receiving the digital traffic channel information, the other mobile station will be able to answer the call. Automatic Contact of the Cordless Cellular Base Station bv the Cellular Network
In order to enable the cellular network 16 to periodically change the operational parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10, cordless cellular base station 10 preferably includes a preset timer which counts down the amount of time since the cordless cellular base station 10 last contacted the cellular network 16. When the timer expires, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically contacts the cellular network 16. In the preferred embodiment, the timer is set for thirty days; thus if the cordless cellular base station 10 has not contacted the cellular network 16 within thirty days, for example, to request a location update for a registered mobile station, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically contacts the cellular network 16. In response the cellular network determines if it is necessary to send the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message. If a new authorization message is required, the cellular network sends the message to the cordless cellular base station. If a new authorization message is not required, the cellular network sends a return result message to the cordless cellular base station. Upon receiving either message from the cellular network, the timer in the cordless cellular base station is reset for thirty days. This feature is advantageous for several reasons. First, this enables the cellular network 16 to regularly update the operational parameters in the cordless cellular base station 10 to accommodate changes in the service in the area around the cordless cellular base station 10 and to update the cordless cellular base station on any changed features of the cellular network 16. For example, the cellular network 16 may temporarily alter the telephone number that the cordless cellular base station 10 calls to access the location update/call forwarding feature.
In addition, this feature is useful in preventing fraudulent usage of a cordless cellular base station 10. For example, if the owner did not pay the bill for the service and also stopped using the cordless cellular base station 10 or kept the mobile stations exclusively at home but continued the use of the CCBS, it would be difficult for the cellular network 16 to remotely cancel the operation of the cordless cellular base station 10, because the cordless cellular base station 10 may not ever contact the cellular network 16. With the automatic contact feature, the cellular network 16 would automatically contact the cordless cellular base station 10 every thirty days. The network 16 could then send a new authorization message removing all of the operating frequencies from the cordless cellular base station which belonged to the non-paying customer, thus making the cordless cellular base station 10 inoperable. Call Initiation and Reception
Referring back to Figure 1-2, when a call is initiated by a registered mobile station 12 that is in the standby mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the air interface transaction required to establish a cellular originated call and connect it to the landline service. Before connecting the call to the land line 14, however, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably checks first to see if the phone number matches the MIN for one of the other mobile stations 12 which is listed in standby mode in the registration table 113 (Figure 8) on the cordless cellular base station 10. If the phone number matches a MIN for the one of the mobile stations 12 listed in standby mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 pages that mobile station 12 and initiates an intercom conversation between the two mobile stations. The intercom feature is described in more detail below. The intercom conversation does not make the landline 14 busy, so the wireline extensions connected to the landline 14 can initiate and receive calls over the landline 14 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10.
If one of the mobile stations calls the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10, only the mobile stations 12 listed as being in standby mode will ring. This is for two reasons. First, the cordless cellular base station 10 does not have the capability of ringing the phones associated with the landline 14 as the ring signal for those phones are provided by the PSTN 15. Further, while it might be possible to set the cordless cellular base station 10 up so it could call the other land line extensions (e.g., by requiring that the CCBS be connected to two separate PSTN Iines), this would add some significant expense for very little additional value. Thus, this is not a preferred embodiment. When a call is received on the landline 14 associated with the cordless cellular base station 10, all the extensions connected to the landline 14 ring and the cordless cellular base station 10 pages all registered mobile stations 12 which are in the standby state. The mobile stations 12 answer the call by pressing a send button on the mobile station 12, the cordless cellular base station 10 transmits the voice signals between the landline 14 and the mobile station 12. Any of the extensions associated with the landline number 14 or any of the mobile stations 12 can answer the ringing. If more than one mobile station 12 answers the call by pressing a send button on a mobile station 12, the cordless cellular base station 10 bridges the call such that each mobile station 12 acts as an "extension." In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 can bridge up to two mobile stations 12 on a single call. If a third mobile station or more attempts to add to the call, the additional mobile stations 12 are denied access to the cordless cellular base station 10 and are not added to the call, thus remaining in standby mode. If at any time a call being handled by the cordless cellular base station 10 is in progress and only one mobile station is listed as being active, a second mobile station 12 in standby mode can be added to the call by pressing the send button on the second mobile station 12. The ability to bridge two calls requires sending two voice signals from the cordless cellular base station 10 to the listener mobile stations 12, as described in more detail below is association with Figures 16-18. If it would be desirable to add additional mobile stations 12 beyond two mobile stations 12 to the same call, additional transceivers could be added to the cordless cellular base station 10, as known to those of skill in the art. Bridging Two Calls on the Cordless Cellular Base Station
When there are two mobile stations 12 bridged by the cordless cellular base station CCBS 10 to a call on the PSTN 15, the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to match the functionality and performance of regular extension telephone operation. Each mobile station 12 is able to receive the voice data from both the other mobile station and the signals from the PSTN 15.
The preferred embodiment utilizes a system in which the sum of the mobile station 12 and the PSTN 15 voice signals are encoded. As shown in Figure 16, the cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 utilizes a CODEC 250 which contains a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 as known to those of skill in the art. For simplicity, Figure 16 shows that two CODECs are used for the cordless cellular base station 10. In the preferred embodiment, only a single CODEC 250 is used and the transmission to/from each mobile station 12 is shifted in time, thus enabling a single CODEC in the cordless cellular base station 10 to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations 12. In the preferred embodiment, the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station (MSI) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are preferably sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communication protocol. The signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal. The voice signal from the first mobile station is summed at summer 256 with the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the 2-wire to 4-wire hybrid device (H). The summed signal is then encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the second mobile station (MS2) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol. The second mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the second mobile station is able to listen to the voices of both parties on the PSTN 15 and on the first mobile station. Similarly, the audio communication from the second mobile station (MS2) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communicatioπ protocol. The signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal. The voice signal from the second mobile station is summed at summer 258 with the voice signal received from the PSTN 15 and encoded by the hybrid device (H). The summed signal is then encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the first mobile station (MS1) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol. The first mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the first mobile station is able to listen to the voices of both parties on the PSTN 15 and on the second mobile station. The voice signal from the second mobile station is summed with the voice signal received from the first mobile station and are encoded by the hybrid device (H) for delivery to the user on the PSTN 15. In a second embodiment, as shown in Figure 17, the cordless cellular base station 10 compares a voice signal from one mobile station with the voice signal from the PSTN and whichever is louder is sent to the other mobile station. Similar to the embodiment of Figure 16, the cordless cellular base station utilizes a CODEC 250 which contains a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 as known to those of skill in the art. For simplicity, Figure 17 shows that two CODECS are used by the cordless cellular base station 10. In the preferred embodiment, only a single CODEC 250 is used and the transmission to/from each mobile station is shifted in time, thus enabling a single CODEC in the cordless cellular base station to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations. In the preferred embodiment, the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station (MS1) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol. The signal is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal. The voice signal from the first mobile station is compared to the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the hybrid device (H) by a voice level comparator (VLC) 260. The voice level comparator 260 selects which of the two signals is louder and controls the operation of a switch 262 to enable the louder of the two signal to pass to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 250 for the second mobile station (MS2) which is encoded into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the second mobile station (MS2) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol. The second mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the second mobile station is only able to listen to the voice of the louder of the parties on the PSTN 15 and on the first mobile station.
Similarly, the communications or voice signals from a second mobile station (MS2) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol. The signal is received by the cordless cellular base station and is decoded by the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to a voice signal. The voice signal from the second mobile station is compared to the voice signal that was received from the PSTN 15 and was coded by the hybrid device (H) by a voice level comparator (VLC) 260. The voice level comparator 260 selects which of the two signals is louder and controls the operation of a switch 262 to enable the louder of the two signal to pass to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 for the first mobile station (MS1) which is encoded into a digitally compressed signal which is sent to the first mobile station (MS1) using the IS-136 cellular communications protocol. The first mobile station decodes the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listener to hear. In this way, the user of the first mobile station is only able to listen to the voice of the louder of the parties on the PSTN 15 and on the second mobile station. Further, the voice signal from the second mobile station is summed with the voice signal received from the first mobile station at summer 264 and are encoded by the hybrid device (H) for delivery to the user on the PSTN 15. In this way, the user on the PSTN 15 can listener to both of the mobile stations regardless of which one is louder.
In a third embodiment, as shown in Figure 18, the cordless cellular base station 10 listens for whichever of the two mobile stations is sending the louder signal and accepts the voice communication from that mobile station. The cordless cellular base station 10 utilizes a CODEC 250 which is made up of a VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and a VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 250 as known to those of skill in the art. In the preferred embodiment, a single CODEC 250 is used to encode and decode voice signals for both mobile stations. In the preferred embodiment, the communication or voice signals from a first mobile station (MS1) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS-136 cellular communication protocol. Similarly, the communication or analog voice signals from a second mobile station (MS2) are digitally encoded by the VSELP speech encoder (VSE) 252 and are sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 using the IS- 136 cellular communication protocol. A detector 266 determines which of the two signals is the louder and passes that signal to the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 which is decoded to a voice signal and is sent to the hybrid for the listener on the PSTN 15 to hear. The signal from the PSTN 15 is sent through the hybrid and to the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 where the signal is digitally compressed. The signal from the VSELP encoder (VSE) 252 is sent to both the first and second mobile station (MS2) using the IS- 136 cellular communications protocol. Once the signal is received at each of the mobile stations (MS1/MS2), they respectively decode the digitally compressed signal using the VSELP speech decoder (VSD) 254 to an audio voice signal for the listeners to hear. In this way, the users of the first and second mobile stations are able to listen to the voice of the party on the PSTN 15; however, the user of each of the mobile stations is unable to hear what is being said by the user of the other mobile station. Intercom Feature
If no call is in progress, the cordless cellular base station 10 has an intercom capability to connect the standby registered mobile stations 12 with each other through the cordless cellular base station 10. Using Figure 16 as an example of the cordless cellular base station 10 circuitry, in the intercom feature, two mobile stations 12 are connected to the cordless cellular base station 10, and there is no speech connection to the PSTN 15. The cordless cellular base station 10 relays the encoded speech data stream from each mobile station 12 to the other without decoding in the cordless cellular base station 10. Each mobile station 12 decodes the received encoded speech data from the other mobile station 12 for the user to hear. Thus, the VSELP processing in the cordless cellular base station described in association with Figures 16-18 is bypassed when the intercom feature is used. Mobile Station Deregistration
The mobile station 12 sends a Power-Down deregistration (which is an IS- 136 message) to the cordless cellular base station 10 when the power to the mobile station 12 is turned off. In addition, the mobile station 12 deregisters from the cordless cellular base station 10 when the cordless cellular base station's signal becomes too weak, i.e., when the mobile station 12 moves out of the range of the cordless cellular base station 10 or when the user presses a soft key sequence on the keypad of the mobile station 12 and forces a deregistration. Upon receipt of any of the deregistration requests listed above, the cordless cellular base station 10 updates the status of the mobile station 12 in the registration list (Figure 8) from an "active" or "standby" status to a dormant status. Further, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably informs the cellular network 16, so that the routing of calls for the mobile station identification number (MIN) to the landline number is disabled. The mobile station 12 may then register with the regional cellular network 16, using measurements of the received signal strengths for the neighboring cells, as is known to those of skill in the art.
In an alternate embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 may request that the mobile station 12 register periodically. In one preferred embodiment, the mobile station 12 registration period is approximately every five minutes; that is, the mobile station 12 needs to register with the cordless cellular base station 10 at least every five minutes to maintain a connection with the cordless cellular base station 10. If the registration of the mobile station 12 is not detected during the five minute registration period, the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically deregisters the mobile station 12, utilizing the deregistration procedure described above.
As described above, typically, when the mobile station 12 severs contact with the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the CCBS VLR to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 is informed during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities that the CCBS VLR wants to be informed. Some examples of types of deregistration events for which the network may want to be contacted are: when the mobile station is turned off, i.e., a power down deregistration, when a manual cancellation of the cordless service mode occurs, i.e., forced deregistration, etc. If one of the specified deregistration events occur, the cordless cellular base station sends a network cancellation message to the CCBS VLR. If the cordless cellular base station 10 is unable to complete the network cancellation of the call forwarding feature on the first attempt, a second attempt is made. If the second attempt is also unsuccessful, no additional actions are required of the cordless cellular base station 10. The calls for the mobile station 12, however, will continue to be forwarded to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10 until the mobile station 12 registers with the cellular network 16 which will automatically update its location and will therefore cancel the old call forwarding message. Network Forwarding Cancellation
Typically, when the mobile station severs contact with the cordless cellular base station 10, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends a network forwarding cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls for the mobile station identification number to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. As indicated above, the CCBS VLR informs the cordless cellular base station during the initial authorization message of which types of registration/deregistration activities that the CCBS VLR would like to be informed.
When it is appropriate to notify the CCBS VLR of the deregistration of the mobile station, the network forwarding cancellation procedure as illustrated in Figure 19a is initiated. The cordless cellular base station (CCBS) 10 calls the remote network update number (the CCBS 10 tries the Remote Network Update Number 1 first and if it is busy it tries the Remote Network Update Number 2) in a network contact calling step (Network Contact Call) 268 via the public switched telephone network 15, to contact the cellular network (CN) 16. The cellular network 16 upon answering the call sets up a modem link in step 272. In an authentication step (AUTH) 274, the cordless cellular base station 10 starts an authorization timer and sends an authentication message to the cellular network 16 which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count for the landline number. Further, the authentication message may include the mobile system identification number for which the call forwarding message is to be canceled. If a mobile system identification number is not included, the cellular network 16 will cancel the call forwarding for all of the mobile stations currently registered with the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station authorization count maintains a running score of the number of updates the cordless cellular base station 10 has made over this landline number as a fraud prevention mechanism. The cellular network 16 compares the call number ID (CNI) from the PSTN for the landline number of the cordless cellular base station 10 which made the call with the landline number for the cordless cellular base station 10 stored in a data base on the cellular network 16. In addition, the cellular network 16 verifies that the mobile system identification number to be updated, if included, the cordless cellular base station identification number and a cordless cellular base station authorization count provided by the cordless cellular base station 10 match the stored values in the cellular network 16. Once the authentication message is processed and validated, a return result message is sent to the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 276 and the cordless cellular base station 10 authorization count is updated. Further, the cellular network 16 sets a message receive timer to see if the cordless cellular base station 10 is going to send it a message. If the authentication message cannot be validated, i.e., if any of the above-referenced values do not match, the cellular network breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure.
In the meantime, the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the retum result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the authentication timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station will process the error and may attempt a new connection with the cellular network 16 after a specified period of time has elapsed.
After receiving the return result message, the cordless cellular base station 10 stops the authentication timer, starts a message receive timer and sends a network cancellation message to the cellular network 16 to cancel the forwarding of calls to the cordless cellular base station in step 278 via a modem link. In a preferred embodiment, the network cancellation message comprises at least the landline number to which the cordless cellular base station 10 is connected. In addition, the network cancellation message may include the mobile system identification number for the mobile station to which the call forwarding cancellation is to apply. If the mobile station identification number is not provided, the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding feature for all mobile stations which are serviced by the cordless cellular base station 10 that is connected to the designated landline. The cellular network 16 receives the network cancellation message from the cordless cellular base station 10, verifies that it agrees with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, and stops the message receive timer. If parameters received from the cordless cellular base station 10 do not agree with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, the cellular network 16 sends an error message to the cordless cellular base station 10 and resets the message receive timer. If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 resends the return result message, resets the message receive timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the network 16 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the parameters received from the cordless cellular base station 10 agree with the stored parameters in the cellular network 16, the cellular network 16 updates the information stored in the cordless cellular base station visitor location register (CCBS VLR) regarding the location of the mobile station and sends a return result message in step 280 to the cordless cellular base station 10 over the modem link to verify the receipt of the information.
In the meantime, the cordless cellular base station 10 is waiting to receive the return result message from the cellular network 16. If the return result message is not received during the message receive timer period or if an error result is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 will process the error and may attempt to resend the location update message after a specified period of time has passed. Once the return result message has been received by the cordless cellular base station 10, the message receive timer is stopped. The cellular network ends the call forwarding cancellation procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 286.
Figure 19b illustrates an alternate embodiment of the network forwarding cancellation procedure, which is the same as the procedure in Figure 19a from steps 268-278. After the network cancellation message is received, the information in the message has been compared with the stored parameters and matches, and the network updates the information regarding the location of the mobile station, the cellular network checks to see if it needs to send an updated authorization message to the cordless cellular base station 10. If the cellular network needs to send an authorization message, instead of sending the return result message as in Figure 19a, the cellular network 16 sends the cordless cellular base station authorization message in step 282, which includes the cordless cellular base station identification number and a list of operational frequencies, which is the same as the initial authorization message described above, and sets a return result timer. If the message receive timer expires and no message has been received from the cellular network 16, cordless cellular base station 10 resends the network cancellation message, resets the timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts, no message has been received from the network 16, the cordless cellular base station 10 breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If an invalid authorization message is received, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends an authorization error message to the cellular network 16, resets the timer, and may wait for the receipt of a new authorization message.
If a valid authorization message is received by the cordless cellular base station 10 in step 282 over the modem link, the cordless cellular base station 10 updates its operational parameters as received in the message and stops the authorization timer. The cellular network 16 is able to revoke the cordless cellular base station's operational authority or update the operational parameters of the cordless cellular base station 10 with the cordless cellular base station authorization message. The cordless cellular base station 10 confirms the receipt of message by sending a return result message to the cellular network 16 in step 284. If the cellular network 16 does not receive the return result message before its retum result timer expires, the cellular network 16 the CCBS authorization message, resets the return result timer, and waits for a response. If after two timeouts no message has been received from the cordless cellular base station 10, the cellular network 16 cancels the call forwarding update, breaks the modem connection, releases the call, and exits the procedure. If the retum result message is received, the cellular network ends the call forwarding cancellation procedure and either the cellular network 16 or the cordless cellular base station 10 releases the call (Release call) in step 286. After the call forwarding cancellation process is complete, the cellular network 16 no longer routes all calls for the mobile station identification number of the registered mobile station 12 to the landline number associated with the cordless cellular base station 10. The procedure for how the cancellation is updated within the cellular network is similar to the process described in association with Figures 19a and 19b above for the initiation of the call forwarding except that the CCBS VLR 228 revokes its location change request from the HLR 224, and it lets the HLR 224 handle all of the requests for the mobile station 12.
Interference Measurement and Avoidance General Overview of Procedure
Referring back to Figures 1 and 2, the cordless cellular base station 10 is designed to operate in the residential home or office environment. This environment can be potentially very noisy because potentially no dedicated frequency spectrum is allocated for the cordless cellular base station operation coupled with the fact that the CCBS frequency usage is not explicitly coordinated with the regional cellular network's frequency use. The cordless cellular base station 10 has to co-exist in the same cellular band used by the regional cellular network 16 and views the regional cellular network 16 as a source of background interference. The cordless cellular base station 10 attempts to avoid the potential interference by the cellular network 16 by choosing frequencies which, as far as the cordless cellular base station 10 can determine, are not being used by nearby regional cells 18 or by other nearby cordless cellular base stations 10.
Since the regional cellular network 16 is unaware of the operating frequency of the cordless cellular base station 10, it is likely that this system will occasionally assign voice or control traffic to a channel on which the cordless cellular base station is operating. Further, it is possible that another cordless cellular base station 10 located close by could be using the same frequency. When such a "collision" between the cordless cellular base station 10 and a regional cellular network 16 happens, priority is given to the regional cellular base station 18. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station 10 implements a channel selection algorithm using software instructions, which are stored in the memory of the cordless cellular base station 10. The processor of the cordless cellular base station preferably operates on the instructions to implement the channel selection algorithm. Since the uplink and downlink channels are assigned in pairs, it is not necessary to constantly monitor both the uplink and downlink frequencies of each pair to determine if the pair is clear. The channel selection algorithm of the preferred embodiment scans the downlink frequencies in the cellular band and determines the best and the next-best downlink cellular frequencies for cordless operation at all times, as described in more detail below. In brief, the cordless cellular base station 10 periodically measures received signal strength (RSS) for each of the authorized downlink frequencies of the cordless cellular base station 10. In addition, the cordless cellular base station takes RSS measurements on the current uplink operational frequency. Finally, when a call is in progress, the cordless cellular base station also makes uplink word error rate (WER) measurements. All of these measurements are known to those of skill in the art. Under certain conditions, the above measurements may also be made by the mobile stations using the IS-136 MAHO measurement capabilities known to those of skill in the art. The mobile station 12 then relays its measurements to the cordless cellular base station 10. The cordless cellular base station 10 translates the RSS and WER measurements into a score increment or decrement value based upon a stored score increment table. After each measurement, the current score increment/decrement value is added to the previous score value. The score for a frequency is a measure of the amount of noise plus interference at a given frequency, thus the score itself is a measure of the potential of interference if this channel were selected rather than the actual interference occurring on the channel. Therefore, throughout this document any discussion of the measurement of the interference on a channel should be interpreted as the measurement of the potential interference on this channel, if the channel was selected for operation. Thus, the interference score represents the potential interference that would be encountered on that frequency, with a higher score representing more interference, and a lower score representing lower interference. In the absence of interference, the score value will gradually decay towards zero as more measurements are made. In addition, when frequencies are found to have significant interference, they are quickly removed from consideration and are only reconsidered after some significant quiet period in accordance with the scoring mechanism and thresholds described in more detail herein.
The cordless cellular base station 10 uses the interference score measurements in making the choice of an operating frequency. By selecting a frequency from those with the lowest interference scores, and by using appropriate channel abandonment thresholds described below, the cordless cellular base station 10 attempts to avoid transmitting on any frequency which is already in use by the public cellular network 16 or by other cordless cellular base stations 10 within range. Preferably, the cordless cellular base station selects for its initial operational frequency the frequency with the lowest interference score. The cordless cellular base station 10 selects for its backup frequencies a specified number of downlink frequencies whose scores are below a high threshold value (Ht). Preferably, depending upon whether a call is in progress or if a primary mobile station is registered, if the interference score of the current operational frequency rises above a first low threshold (Lt) or above the high threshold (Ht), the cordless cellular base station 10 automatically switches its operational frequency to the first backup frequency as described in more detail below. The cordless cellular base station 10 also removes backup frequencies from the back-up frequency list if the interference score rises above the high threshold (Ht). The cordless cellular base station needs to locate a specified number of downlink frequencies (referred to herein as M) having score values below the high threshold value (Ht). If a sufficient number of frequencies are not available, i.e., less than M frequencies are available, the cordless cellular base station 10 notifies the cellular network 16 of the problem. In one embodiment, the cellular network will provide the cordless cellular base station with a list of altemative frequencies for operation. In another embodiment, the cellular network 16 will temporarily disable the cordless cellular base station 10 for a specified period of time and then will enable its operation on the same frequencies which are hopefully free from interference at this later time. The remainder of the interference measurement procedure is described in more detail below. Interference Measurement
The cordless cellular base station 10 has a variety of different modes of operation that affect the number and type of interference measurements that are performed. In the basic operational mode when the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for use and none of its registered mobile stations 12 are processing a call, i.e., are in an active state, the cordless cellular base station 10 performs an interference measurement during time slot 4 (40) of the cordless cellular base station transmit time frame 36. Referring to Figure 4, if either zero or one call is being processed by the cordless cellular base station 10, the receiver will be silent on timeslot 5 (41) of the receive time frame 35 because the mobile station will not be sending voice information for the digital traffic channel of the second mobile station (DT2). Further, the transmitter does not transmit any information on timeslot 4 (40) of the transmit time frame 36, the cordless cellular base station 10 will not be generating any of its own interference and thus can make an accurate measurement of the interference generated by its environment. When the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the interference on its own operating frequency, the strength of the interference received on the receiver is measured when no transmission is specifically broadcast to the receiver of the cordless cellular base station, as known to those of skill in the art. When the cordless cellular base station 10 measures activity on a downlink frequency other than the operating frequency, the received signal strength (RSS) in dBm is the noise plus interference power (NPIP). The cordless cellular base station 10 can measure signal strength on the downlink operating frequency, i.e., the frequency used by the cellular base station to communicate with the mobile station 12, during the cordless cellular base station's silent transmission period in Time Slot 4 (40) of the TDMA transmission frame 36. If fewer than two mobile stations 12 are active, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the receive signal strength on the uplink operating frequency, i.e., the frequency used by the cellular base station to communicate with the mobile station 12, during unused time slots as described in more detail below.
When the cordless cellular base station 10 measures signal strength and word error rate (WER) in a digital traffic channel (DTC) time slot on the uplink operating frequency, the RSS includes both the desired signal and the noise and interference. For these measurements, the cordless cellular base station 10 first converts the measured word error rate (WER) into an equivalent signal to noise-plus-interfereπce ratio (SNIR), using the conversation factors known to those of skill in the art. Once the SNIR has been determined, the cordless cellular base station 10 estimates the noise-pius-interference signal strength as:
R S S
N P I P S N I R
where RSS is the total received power.
The measurement result is expressed as a power equivalent (in dBm) of the noise plus interference (NPIP) value. Interference Measurements in Various Modes of Operation
As indicated above, the cordless cellular base station 10 has several different modes of operation that affect the number and type of measurements that can be performed. Each of the modes of operation and the types of measurements made in each mode are described in more detail in the subsections below. In addition, all of the modes of operation and the types of measurements which can be performed in each mode are summarized in Table 1 below.
TABLE 1: Cordless Cellular Base Station Measurement Modes
Cordless Cellular Measurements Made By: Base Station Mode cordless cellular base mobile station station
Silent, prior to receipt of a list of none none allowed frequencies
Silent, with list of allowed frequencies downlink RSS on all none authorized frequencies; fast measurement
DCCH only, no mobile station present or downlink RSS on all none mobile station in standby authorized frequencies and uplink RSS on fg
DTC, one mobile station call-connected optional downlink RSS MAHO, downlink WER on all authorized frequencies, uplink RSS on fg only uplink WER
DTC, two mobile stations call-connected uplink WER only MAHO, downlink WER
Cordless Cellular Base Station Measurements In Silent Mode
The silent mode encompasses all states in which the cordless cellular base station's transmitter is turned off. The cordless cellular base station's transmitter is turned off for a number of reasons: (1) the cordless cellular base station 10 has not received network authorization to transmit; (2) transmit authorization has been received, but there are an insufficient number of acceptable operating frequencies, i.e., frequencies with interference scores below Ht; (3) the cordless cellular base station 10 has found an insufficient number of initially acceptable operating frequencies when it abandoned its last operating frequency; or (4) transmit authorization has been revoked. Silent Mode, Prior to Receipt of a List of Authorized Frequencies In silent mode, prior to the receipt of a list of authorized frequencies from the cellular network during the initial authorization procedure, the cordless cellular base station 10 is not required to make interference measurements. In addition, since the list of authorized frequencies has not been received, no mobile stations 12 have been allowed to register with the cordless cellular base station 10, so no mobile stations 12 have to report any measurements either. Silent Mode. After Receipt of a List of Authorized Freouencies
After the receipt of a list of authorized frequencies, the cordless cellular base station 10 may for a period of time have an insufficient number of acceptable clear channels so the transmitter is silent. In another case, the cordless cellular base station 10 may have an insufficient number of acceptable channels when it abandoned its last operating frequency and is temporarily silent. Without at least one clear channel, the cordless cellular base station 10 cannot communicate with any of the mobile stations so the cordless cellular base station has no phone related transmission or reception duties. Therefore, the cordless cellular base station can make interference measurements on all of the time slots 1-6. Because additional time slots are available for making interference measurements, the cordless cellular base station is referred to as being in a fast interference measurement mode. In the fast interference measurement mode, the measurement rate is expected to be substantially higher than one measurement per TDMA frame. Further, in this mode the cordless cellular base station only measures the down link frequencies so it can establish a sufficient number of clear channels below the Ht threshold. In a preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station should have M channels with interference scores below Ht before initial operation can begin. Once the cordless cellular base station finds a sufficient number of ciear channels with scores below the Ht threshold, the cordless cellular base station preferably selects the frequency with the lowest interference score to be the downlink operating frequency and starts broadcasting its DCCH on this frequency. At this point, the cordless cellular base station moves into its authorized mode. Cordless Cellular Base Station Measurements in Authorized Mode
On receipt of authorization to transmit, the cordless cellular base station 10 first notes the list of allowed frequencies given in the authorization transaction. Interference measurements are restricted to this set of allowed frequencies. Note that this list could include all frequencies in the cellular frequency range.
When the cordless cellular base station 10 is authorized for operation (transmitting a DCCH), the cordless cellular base station 10 makes several types of measurements, depending on the operating mode. No Mobile Stations in Active Mode
When no mobile stations 12 are active, the cordless cellular base station 10 makes downlink RSS measurements for all of the authorized downlink frequencies using the scheme described below and uplink RSS measurements for the current uplink frequency only. When no mobile stations 12 are in an active mode, the cordless cellular base station 10 is transmitting its half -rate digital control channel on time slot 1, there are no required transmissions on time slots 2, 3, 5, and 6 besides idle codes because there is no call in progress to send voice information for DTC1 or DTC2. Further, as described above the cordless cellular base station 10 will normally be silent during Time Slot 4 and during this silence in time slot 4 of the transmission frame, at a time when neither the transmitter nor the receiver is in use, the cordless cellular base station 10 will make interference measurements, as described below.
Preferably, the cordless cellular base station 10 nominally makes one downlink interference measurement in time slot 4 per TDMA frame. The downlink frequency to be measured are chosen as follows: (1) in 50% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the current downlink operating frequency; (2) in 25% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the three downlink backup frequencies; (3) in 20% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is below the low threshold (Lt); (4) in 5% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is at or above the low threshold (Lt).
When the downlink operating frequency is measured, the estimated noise plus interference is correlated with all other estimates of noise plus interference on the operating frequency available for this 40 ms TDMA frame. The largest interference estimate is used, and any others are ignored. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below. The uplink RSS measurements are made as follows. Since no mobile stations are active on receive time slots 2, 3, 5 and 6, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures uplink RSS at least once per frame in one of these time slots. The RSS measurement is used as an estimated noise-plus-interference signal strength on the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with other estimates of the noise plus interference on the operating frequency and the largest interference estimate is determined. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
One Mobile Station in Active Mode
In one embodiment, when one mobile station 12 is active, the cordless cellular base station 10 makes uplink RSS and WER measurements for the current uplink frequency only and the mobile station 12 makes downlink WER measurements and forwards them to the cordless cellular base station. In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station also makes downlink RSS measurements of all of the authorized downlink frequencies using the scheme described below. However, in other embodiments, the cordless cellular base station may not make downlink RSS measurements.
The cordless cellular base station 10 nominally makes one downlink RSS interference measurement on time slot 4 per TDMA frame. The downlink frequency to be measured is chosen as follows: (1) in 50% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures the current downlink operating frequency; (2) in 25% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the three backup downlink frequencies; (3) in 20% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is below Lt; (4) in 5% of the 40 ms frames in which a measurement is made, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures one of the other allowed downlink frequencies whose score is at or above Lt. When the downlink operating frequency is measured, the estimated noise plus interference is correlated with all other estimates of noise plus interference on the operating frequency available for this 40 ms TDMA frame. The largest interference estimate is used, and any others are ignored. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
When one mobile station 12 is active, the CCBS establishes the digital traffic channel on receive time slots 3 and 6, i.e., DTC1. However, time slots 2 and 5 are still unused, therefore the cordless cellular base station 10 may attempt to measure uplink RSS at least once per frame in one of these available time slots. Preferably, the uplink RSS measurement is made during the receive time slot 5 as it is most likely not to receive interference from the transmission of the DCCH of the cordless cellular base station. The RSS measurement is used as an estimated noise-plus-interference signal strength on the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with other estimates of the noise plus interference on the operating frequency and the largest interference estimate is determined.
Besides measuring the RSS uplink information, the cordless cellular base station 10 also measures the uplink WER for the Digital Traffic Channel (DTC) being received from that mobile station 12 at least once, and more preferably twice, per 40 ms TDMA frame. The uplink WER and uplink RSS measurements are combined per the equation described above to achieve an uplink noise plus interference measurement for the operating frequency. This estimate is compared with all other estimates of noise plus interference available for this 40 ms TDMA frame (for example signal quality reports from the mobile) and the largest interference estimate is determined. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below.
When one of the cordless cellular base station's mobile stations is in the active mode, the mobile station, in compliance with IS-136, will be making downlink MAHO RSS and WER interference measurements of its own since the CCBS will command it to do so. The cordless cellular base station 10 receives these measurements from the mobile station 12 and scores them as discussed below.
In order to ensure that proper communication is maintained with the mobile station 12, besides receiving interference measurement scores from the mobile station 12, the cordless cellular base station 10 updates the mobile's MAHO neighbor list each two to ten seconds. Preferably, the mobile's MAHO neighbor list is updated every five seconds. As specified in the IS-136 standard, the digital control channel DCCH from a base station to a mobile station 12 can send control information using one of two control channel formats, the fast associated control channel (FACCH) and the slow associated control channel (SACCH) formats.
The SACCH format uses a concatenated set of 12-bit fields from multiple TDMA bursts to transmit control information during the normal DTC. The FACCH format is used when the control information is longer and cannot wait for the next DTC time slot to send the balance of the message. Since the FACCH message steals voice capacity from the digital traffic channel, it is preferable to wait to send the FACCH message until there is a detectable silence in the conversation on the digital traffic channel so the users will not detect the interruption during which the FACCH message is sent. The neighbor list update is sent using the FACCH, therefore the cordless cellular base station 10 is required to detect voice activity (possibly based on the RO level of the VSELP codec) to determine when a quiet period has occurred during the conversation to send the neighbor list update message for minimum degradation of voice quality. The neighbor list update message is preferably sent at the first opportunity (i.e., when silence in the voice signal from the cordless cellular base station 10 to the mobile is detected) after the MAHO report from the previous list has been received. If there is no opportunity within ten seconds, the cordless cellular base station 10 sends the neighbor list update message regardless.
As per the IS- 136 standard, the MAHO neighbor list preferably comprises up to twenty-four downlink frequencies. In the case of the cordless cellular base station, the twelve downlink frequencies are chosen from the list of authorized downlink frequencies assigned to the cordless cellular base station. In the preferred embodiment, the twelve downlink frequencies comprise the three backup frequencies selected by the cordless cellular base station, plus nine from the remaining authorized downlink frequencies for the cordless cellular base station. Preferably, seven of the nine frequencies are selected among the frequencies whose score is below Lt. If there are fewer than seven such frequencies, the cordless cellular base station 10 includes ail the frequencies whose interference scores are below Lt. The balance of the nine frequencies are selected from among the remaining frequencies, other than the current operating frequency.
Two Mobile Stations in Active Mode With two mobile stations 12 connected to a call (two DTCs in use), the cordless cellular base station 10 cannot measure signal strength during Time Slot 4 of the CCBS transmit frame. This is because time slot 5 of the CCBS receive frame occurs at the same time as transmit time slot 4, and the cordless cellular base station's receiver is used during the receive frame time slot 5 as part of the second digital traffic channel (DTC2) for the second mobile station 12. In this mode, the cordless cellular base station can only monitor the uplink WER and RSS for each of the mobile stations. Thus, the cordless cellular base station 10 must rely on the downlink RSS MAHO measurements and the downlink WER measurements from the two mobile stations 12, which necessarily excludes the measurement of the current operating frequency of each of the mobile stations. Thus the cordless cellular base station 10 loses the ability to measure the RSS of interference on the operating frequency, unless the interference is large enough to affect the word error rates (WERs). Thus, in compliance with IS-136, both of the mobile stations will be making MAHO downlink RSS and downlink WER interference measurements of their own. The cordless cellular base station 10 receives these measurements from either one of the mobile stations 12 and scores the measurements as discussed below.
With two mobile stations 12 in an active state, the only measurement that the cordless cellular base station 10 can make itself is the uplink WER and RSS measurements for each of the digital traffic channels (DTC) of the mobile stations 12. The uplink WER measurement is made twice per 40 ms TDMA frame per digital traffic channel (DTC). The uplink WER measurements from the cordless cellular base station 10 is combined with the downlink RSS MAHO measurement and the downlink WER measurement made by one of the mobile stations and used as a measurement of downlink noise plus interference. The cordless cellular base station 10 scores this frequency, as discussed below. Score Determination In the preferred embodiment, the interference measurements are translated into a score increment or decrement. The interference score for each frequency can preferably range from 0 to 22 -1. In addition, the CCBS VLR provides the cordless cellular base station 10 with the initial score value for each of the operational frequencies in the authorization message that is sent by the cellular network 16. In another embodiment, the initial score value is set to be a default value when the CCBS is manufactured. In a preferred embodiment, on power-up or reset, the cordless cellular base station 10 initializes the frequency scores to a value equivalent to the high threshold (Ht) + 7500. This makes these frequencies initially unacceptable for use but available if they stay clear for 5 minutes, which is equivalent to 7500 40 ms TDMA frames. On subsequent receipt of a new list of allowed frequencies, the cordless cellular base station 10 initializes scores on any frequencies that were not previously allowed to Ht+7500. In another embodiment, certain of the new frequencies on the allowed frequency list may be sent with preassigned initial values. The frequencies which are sent with preassigned initial values will override the initial value set at the time of manufacturing or previously provided by the CCBS VLR.
The cordless cellular base station 10 takes the interference measurement for each frequency which is expressed as a power equivalent (in dBm) of the noise plus interference and translates the measured noise plus interference power level into a score increment or decrement using a staircase function 288 in Figure 20. The cordless cellular base station 10 determines between which X values the interference measurement occurs and reads the appropriate decrement or increment value from the Y axis.
As indicated below in the preferred embodiment the X values for a mobile station measurement are different from the X values for the cordless cellular base station measurement. The reason for this difference is that the mobile station 12 will be able to move from inside the home or office environment to outside of the home or office environment and it is believed that it will be subject to a slightly elevated level of interference because of its ability to be located outside. The cordless cellular base station 10, on the other hand, is stationary and will remain inside where it is believed that it will be subjected to less interference. To reconcile this difference, less interference detected by the cordless cellular base station 10 is required to make a larger jump in the interference score. For example, in the preferred embodiment, a -90 dBm measurement by the cordless cellular base station 10 would result in an interference score at the Y3 level, whereas -90 dBm measurement by the mobile station 12 would result in an interference score at the Y2 level. The preferred X values for Figure 20 are shown in Table 2 below:
TABLE 2: Preferred 'X' Coordinate Values for the Staircase Function
Figure imgf000050_0001
As shown in the table, the value for X1 for the cordless cellular base station is set at 6 dBm above the receiver's noise floor. In the preferred embodiment, the receiver's noise floor is -118 dBm, thus the preferred value for X1 for the cordless cellular base station is -112 dBm.
The preferred Y values for Figure 20 are shown in Table 3 below:
TABLE 3: Preferred T Coordinate Values for the Staircase Function
Figure imgf000050_0002
where Ymaχ is the full-scale (saturation) value of the score. In the preferred embodiment, Ymaχ is 222-1. When an mobile station 12 is present and in active (conversation) mode, the value of N in this table is replaced by N/2.
In effect, this gives the cordless cellular base station 10 and mobile station 12 measurements each half of the total weight.
As shown in the preferred Y value table, the values of Yg and Y2 are proportional to the interval between successive measurements on the frequency in question. This normalizes the measurements, making the decay rate for a score on a clear frequency independent of the measurement rate. For example, once a particular score reaches
22 the saturation value, removal of the interference will cause the score to decay to zero in 2 -1 times 40 ms; about 2 days. The values of X1r X2, X3, Yg, Y , and Y3, as well as the number of steps in the staircase function 288, are the currently preferred values. It is contemplated that these values would be changed depending upon the actual use of the system in order to maintain the goals of quickly removing frequencies from consideration when they are found to have significant interference and only reconsider new frequencies after some significant quiet period.
The cordless cellular base station 10 adds the increment or decrement value read from the Y axis to the previous interference score for the measured frequency. The increment values of the Y axis were chosen such that interference above the X3 value will cause a large jump in the interference score and will quickly make this channel undesirable for use as either a backup frequency or an operating frequency. Whereas, interference between the X3 value and the X2 value will cause a medium size jump in the interference score which should make it undesirable for use as an operating frequency, but could make it useable as a backup frequency depending upon how persistent this level of interference is. Interference between the X2 value and the X^ will not change the present score value, so the channel will remain in its current use level. Interference below the X1 value will enable the interference score to be decremented, thus making it more desirable for use as a potential backup or operational frequency. The increment and decrement values were chosen such that continual interference measurements on the same frequency causes the score to increase rapidly to quickly alert the cordless cellular base station 10 of the interference. Further, occasional interference which is bursty in nature, i.e., sometimes detected on the channel sometimes not detected on the channel, causes the score to increase more slowly but if persistent it eventually can lead to the channel scoring unacceptably high. Finally, when there is little or no interference, i.e., below the X1 value, a decrement allows the score to slowly decay toward zero. Score Storage
The cordless cellular base station 10 stores the scores for each of the operational frequencies in a data base, such as the date base shown in Table 4 below. Table 4 is provided without any of these scores shown. The cordless cellular base station 10 normalizes the score increments and decrements according to the interval between measurements. Therefore, the table below also stores the number of TDMA frames which have occurred between measurements to normalize the interference scores as described in more detail below. In a preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 is able to operate on any of the available four hundred sixteen "A" side or "B" side pairs of uplink and downlink frequencies in the cellular frequency bands. In one embodiment, as described above, the cellular network 16 offers the cordless cellular base station 10 a list, or range of frequencies, carved out of the cellular frequency bands within which to operate. To efficiently use the measurement capabilities of the cordless cellular base station 10 and its mobile stations 12, the cordless cellular base station 10, once authorized by the cellular network 16 with such a frequency list supplied, does not update or otherwise maintain the scores of frequencies which are not on the network-supplied list of frequencies that the cordless cellular base station 10 is enabled to use.
TABLE 4: Interference Scores Maintained by Cordless Cellular Base Station
Number N of TDMA frames since the last measurement by:
Interference frequency score cordless cellular mobile station 1 mobile station 2 base station
1
2
3
...
Figure imgf000052_0001
Normalizing Measurements
Since measurement rates are not uniform over time, the cordless cellular base station 10 must normalize the score increments and decrements according to the interval between measurements. The score updating process requires the cordless cellular base station 10 to track the update rate. The update rate is expressed as the number N of 40 ms TDMA frames since the last interference measurements on any given frequency. Any one frequency may have different update rates from different measurement sources. The range of possible values for N is limited depending upon the measurement mode, as described below.
The value of N will, in general, be different for measurements made by the cordless cellular base station 10, the first mobile station 12, and the second mobile station 12. The value of N depends on the measurement mode, and can be calculated as indicated in Table 5 below. The following abbreviations are used in the table: (1) fod is the operating downlink frequency; (2) fQU is the operating uplink frequency; (3) f1( f2 and f3 are the three backup frequencies; (4) nb is the number of backup frequencies; (5) n)ow is the number of allowed frequencies other than f0-f3 which have scores less than Lt; and (6) nhiph is the number of allowed frequencies other than f -f3 which have scores greater than or equal to Lt.
TABLE 5: Preferred Interference Measurement Rates
cordless cellular Number N of TDMA frames base station mode since the last measurement cordless cellular base mobile station 1 mobile station 2 station
Silent, with a list 416/6 no measurements no measurements of allowed frequencies
DCCH only, no fod:2/0.875 no measurements no measurements mobile stations O-5 present or mobile f1.3:4nb/0.875 stations in standby < Lt:5n,ow/0.875
> Lt:20nhiαh//0.875
DTC, mobile station fod:2/0.875 ?5 no measurements 1 active, mobile fQU:1 [measured each station 2 not frame] < Lt:75n|ow/7 present or in f1.3:4nb/0.875 > Lt:75nhigh/2 standby < Lt:5nlow/0.875
> Lt:20nhiDh/0.875
DTC, two mobile fod:no measurements ?5 stations active fou:1 [measured each frame] < Lt:75n|ow/7
> Lt:75nhjqh/2[all measured by one mobile station]
For example, consider the measurements made by the cordless cellular base station 10 with one mobile station 12 in active mode (third row, first cell of the above table). In this example, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on the operating frequency fod once every two frames, except that 1 of 8 such measurements is preempted by an idle code transmission as described above. This pre-emption of downlink measurements accounts for the divisor 0.875 here and elsewhere in the cordless cellular base station 10 column of the table. With one mobile active, as described above, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures uplink interference of the operating frequency fou once per frame. Since these measurements do not occur in Time Slot 4, they are never preempted for an idle code transmission, thus N is 1. The cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on one of the downlink backup frequencies f-|.3 at an average interval of four frames (25 percent of the measurement frames as describe above). Thus, to measure all the backup frequencies one time requires 4nb frames, and again the 0.875 divisor must be applied because the measurements are preempted for the occasional idle code transmission in time slot 4. In 20 percent of the measurement frames, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on one of the allowed frequencies with scores below Lt. This means an average of 5/0.875 frames between non-preempted measurements, or 5n(ow/0.875 frames before all these frequencies can be measured once. In 5 percent of the measurement frames, the cordless cellular base station 10 measures downlink interference on one of the allowed frequencies with scores equal to or greater than Lt. This means an average of 20/0.875 frames between non-preempted measurements, or 20nhj_h/0.875 frames before all these frequencies can be measured once.
The mobile station's measurements in active (conversation) mode are listed in the third row, second cell of the above table. These values assume an average of three seconds (IS- 136's allowable range is two to ten seconds) between successive MAHO reports. The measurements are as follows: One indirect measurement of downlink interference on the operating frequency every 75 frames (- three seconds) is taken. For this measurement, the cordless cellular base station 10 combines the mobile station's downlink WER and downlink RSS results using the equation described above to achieve the noise plus interference measurement. One direct measurement of downlink interference on each backup frequency is taken every 75 frames. As described above, all downlink backup frequencies are on every MAHO list. Every 75 frames, measurements of downlink interference on seven of the allowed frequencies on the MAHO list with scores below Lt are taken. This works out to 75niow/7 frames to measure each of these frequencies once. Every 75 frames, measurements of downlink interference are taken on two of the allowed frequencies with scores equal to or greater than Lt. This works out to 75n(ow/2 frames to measure each of these frequencies once. Frequency Selection
The cordless cellular base station 10 uses its interference scores as the input to its decisions to select, retain, or abandon an operating frequency or a backup frequency. Changes in operating or backup frequencies result from the score on the frequency exceeding a specified threshold. The two thresholds used by the cordless cellular base station 10 are the high threshold, Ht, and the low threshold, Lt. In the preferred embodiment, Ht is set to Ymax'2' e1ual t0 221- aπd Lt is set t0 Ymax'8, eo < ual t0 2 - ln oπe embodiment, the low and high thresholds are set to be equal.
The cordless cellular base station 10 forms a ranked list of 4M, or four times M, downlink frequencies with the lowest acceptable interference scores from the above list of all frequency scores. Only downlink frequencies whose interference scores are below the High Threshold (Ht) are eligible for inclusion in this list. Therefore, under some conditions the list will contain fewer than 4M frequencies. In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 recompiles this ranked list every two seconds.
The cordless cellular base station 10 also maintains an unranked list of all frequencies with interference scores less than a Low Threshold (Lt). In the preferred embodiment, the cordless cellular base station 10 recompiles this list at least once every two seconds. Figure 21 shows a simplified example of the interference score 290 for a particular frequency (note this example does not take into consideration the status of a call or if a primary mobile station is registered with the cordless cellular base station). At point A, when the interference score rises above Lt, the cordless cellular base station 10 would abandon this frequency if this were the operating frequency and if the other scores were below Lt. At point B, when the interference score rises above Ht, this frequency is unconditionally rejected for use as either an operating or backup frequency. At point C, when the interference score decays below Ht, this frequency once again becomes eligible for selection as a backup or operating frequency. Initial Selection and Reselection of the Operating Frequency
The initial downlink operating frequency is preferably the frequency on the authorized frequency list with the lowest interference score, namely the frequency at the top of the ranked list. If fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 will preferably not begin transmitting and will alert the CCBS VLR of the problem.
Whenever the score of the current downlink operating frequency is updated, the cordless cellular base station 10 evaluates the new score to decide whether or not to change the operating frequency. In the preferred embodiment, the rules for changing the operating frequency also depend upon whether the primary mobile stations are registered or if a call is in progress. Thus, in the preferred embodiment, if the cordless cellular base station's primary mobile station 12 is in active or standby mode or if any of the registered mobile stations are on a call,: the cordless cellular base station 10 will no longer operate on the current operating frequency if: its interference score equals or exceeds Lt and if the first backup frequency's interference score is lower than the operating frequency's score. If the cordless cellular base station's primary mobile station 12 is in the dormant mode, and if no digital traffic channel (DTC) is active, i.e., none of the registered mobile stations are on a call: the cordless cellular base station 10 will no longer operate on the current operating frequency if: its interference score equals or exceeds Ht, otherwise, the cordless cellular base station will remain on its current operating frequency until the primary mobile station user registers with the cordless cellular base station or the interference level exceeds Ht. This feature is provided, so that the primary user's phone can automatically locate its cordless cellular base station 10 when it comes into proximity with it. If the cordless cellular base station 10 were frequently changing its operating frequency when the primary mobile station was not registered, it would be possible for the mobile station 12 to change frequencies such that the current operational frequency was not on the list of the operating and backup frequencies that the mobile station 12 stored when it last registered with the cordless cellular base station 10. Thus, the primary mobile station would not be able to automatically locate and register with the cordless cellular base station 10, because it would not be aware of the current operating frequency of the base station 10, and would therefore not know where to look for its new frequency. In this situation, the user would need to manually invoke a test registration by the mobile station.
If the cordless cellular base station 10 ceases to operate on the current operating frequency, the replacement operating frequency is the first backup frequency fj. If a call is active at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 abandons the operating frequency, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably performs a handoff to the new frequency, using a handoff procedure known to those of skill in the art. However, in a typical handoff the mobile station would be switching from one cell to another. In the case of a handoff initiated by the cordless cellular base station, the mobile station remains in the same cell (the cordless cellular base station cell) and changes its operating frequencies. Since the same radio transceiver remains in control of the call while switching frequencies, the handoff procedure is carefully controlled to ensure that the transceiver does not lose the call while it tunes to the new frequency. If a call is not in progress, the cordless cellular base station 10 will change its operating frequency to the first backup frequency f-| and will notify the mobile stations 12 listed in standby mode by sending the new operating frequency in the next neighbor list message as described above.
If, at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 abandons its operating frequency, fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably contacts the CCBS VLR and informs the CCBS VLR that it does not have enough clear channels for operation. The CCBS VLR may send the cordless cellular base station an new set of channels, or may send it a lower M value, or may send the cordless cellular base station an empty list of authorized frequencies which will cause it to cease transmission until a new set of authorized frequencies are provided. The cordless cellular base station 10 will make its own measurements and maintain interference scores for the newly supplied list of authorized frequencies. Once there are M or more frequencies with scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 begins transmitting on one of the frequencies with an interference score below Ht.
In an alternate embodiment, at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 abandons its operating frequency, fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 ceases to transmit its DCCH. The cordless cellular base station 10 will make its own measurements and maintain interference scores, regularly and frequently checking the number of frequencies whose scores are below Ht. Once there are M or more frequencies with scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 randomly chooses a waiting time, uniformly distributed between 0 and 5 minutes. After this waiting time expires, and provided that there are still M or more frequencies with scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 begins transmitting, preferably on the frequency with the lowest score. In order to avoid dropping a call in progress, the cordless cellular base station 10 temporarily sets M-1 while a digital traffic channel (DTC) is in use. When the call ends (i.e., when neither DTC is in use), the cordless cellular base station 10 will reset M to its true value. If the cordless cellular base station 10 changed its operating frequency during the call, the cordless cellular base station 10 applies the following congestion test after the end of the call: If fewer than M frequencies have scores below Ht, the cordless cellular base station 10 preferably contacts the CCBS VLR and informs the CCBS VLR that it does not have enough clear channels for operation. The CCBS VLR may send the cordless cellular base station a new set of channels, or may send a lower M value, or may send the cordless cellular base station an empty list of frequencies which will cause it to cease transmission until a new set of authorized frequencies are provided. Initial Selection and Reselection of Backup Freouencies For both initial and subsequent selection, the cordless cellular base station 10 chooses each backup frequency equiprobably from the top 2M (two times M) frequencies in the ranked list of the best acceptable frequencies maintained in the cordless cellular base station 10 score table. The operating frequency is removed from the ranked list before the backup frequency is chosen. The reason that the backup frequencies are equiprobably chosen from the list of possible frequencies rather than being chosen deterministically is that it prevents two neighboring cordless cellular base stations from selecting the same set of backup frequencies. If the best interference scores where chosen, it would be highly likely that two neighboring cordless cellular base stations would have similarly ranked interference score measurements for similar channels. If similar backup frequencies were chosen for neighboring cordless cellular base stations, the chances of the neighboring cordless cellular base stations selecting the same frequency as their new operation frequency and resulting in the occurrence of a collision would be very high. By equiprobably choosing the backup frequencies from the list of suitable frequencies, the chances of two neighboring cordless cellular base stations having the same set of backup frequency is greatly lessened. Whenever the score of one of the backup frequencies is updated, the cordless cellular base station 10 evaluates the new score to decide whether or not to change this backup frequency. If the interference score of a backup frequency exceeds Ht or exceeds the (4M)-th position in the overall ranking, the cordless cellular base station 10 replaces this backup frequency. When replacing a backup frequency, the cordless cellular base station 10 maintains the ordering of the backup frequency list {f-, f2, f3} for proper ordering in the broadcast neighbor list. The replacement backup frequency becomes f3. If the old f3 was not replaced, it becomes f2. If the old f2 was not replaced, it becomes
'I-
Example of Score-Based Frequency Selection and Reselection The following example described in association with Figure 22 is used to help clarify the frequency selection concepts. In this example, there are three allowed frequencies, labeled a, b, and c. In addition, for this example, M is set at two, thus two frequencies having a score below Ht must be available to enable operation of the cordless cellular base station and it is assumed that a primary mobile station is registered with the cordless cellular base station. Figure 22 shows the interference scores for these three frequencies as a function of time, and the cordless cellular base station's selection of operating frequency fg and backup frequencies f 1 and f2 as a function of time. Initially frequencies (a) and (b) are acceptable for use. Since frequency (a) has the lower score, it becomes the operating frequency and (b) becomes the first backup. At time t1 # frequency (c) becomes acceptable and is added as the second backup.
At time t2, the score for the operating frequency (a) exceeds Lt. The first backup frequency (b), which has a lower score than does frequency (a), becomes the new operating frequency. The second backup moves up to first position, and the former operating frequency (a) is chosen as the replacement backup frequency.
At time t3, the score for the second backup frequency (a) exceeds Ht and it is therefore removed from the backup list.
At time t4, the score for the operating frequency (b) exceeds Lt and in the preferred embodiment, the primary mobile station is registered with the cordless cellular base station. The first backup frequency (c), which has a lower score than does frequency (b), becomes the new operating frequency. Due to the intermittent or weak nature of the interference, the interference score for the former operating frequency (b) it still below Ht. Therefore frequency (b) is chosen as the replacement backup frequency.
At time t5, the score for the first backup frequency (b) exceeds Ht and it is therefore removed from the backup list. This leaves only one frequency with an acceptable score. Although this would seem to violate the rule that the minimum number of frequencies below Ht (M) must be at least 2, this constraint is only enforced at the time the cordless cellular base station 10 changes its operating frequency. For intermittent or weak interference, the constraint is M-1 acceptable frequencies for continued operation, versus M acceptable frequencies for initial operation. Thus the cordless cellular base station 10 continues to transmit at time tg.
At time tg, frequency (a) becomes acceptable and is added as the first backup. At time t7, frequency (b) becomes acceptable and is added as the second backup. Quick Start
The quick start feature enables the cordless cellular base station 10 to quickly become operable using a few frequencies, referred to as "quick start frequencies", supplied by the cellular network 16 which are known to be clear channels in the area where the cordless cellular base station is located. The goal for the use of the quick start frequencies is to get the cordless cellular base station operating quickly using these dedicated frequencies and then to migrate them off of these frequencies to other channels as they are found to be clear. In one embodiment, these cordless cellular base station downlink frequencies are set aside by the registered cellular network to permit the use of the cordless cellular base station as a sort of safe haven. In a preferred embodiment, in the initial authorization message, the cordless cellular base station 10 is sent two sets of frequencies. The first set is a short list of frequencies known to be clear by the cellular network 16, referred to as quick start frequencies," which are provided with a low initial interference score. The second set is a large set of frequencies with high initial interference scores. Preferably, the initialization score for the quick start frequencies is at least close to the high threshold Ht. By starting out with a low initial interference score, the quick start frequencies will quickly become available for use as an operating frequency as their score will continue to decrement, since the frequency is clear, until at least one of the frequencies falls below the high threshold (Ht) and can be used as the initial operating frequency. In a more preferred embodiment, the initialization score for the quick start frequencies is below the high threshold Ht, so all of the quick start frequencies will immediately be available for use as the operating frequency. In addition to the two sets of frequencies, the cellular network 16 will provide an initial value Mj for M, the minimum number of clear channels the cordless cellular base station needs to operate. In the initial authorization message, M is equal to the number of quick start frequencies provided. This scheme would be useful in a spectrally congested are such as a tall building.
After a specified period of time X, the cellular network 16 will try to migrate the cordless cellular base station 10 off the quick start frequencies. In the preferred embodiment, this period of time X will be forty-eight hours. During the next network update (either a location update or a network cancellation) after the expiration of X, the cellular network 16 will increase M to Mn, the requirement for the minimum number of clear channels for the cordless cellular base station to maintain operation. This information is given to the cordless cellular base station in an authorization message which is sent back from the cellular network to the cordless cellular base station 10 after the location update or network cancellation process has been completed as described in more detail above. If the cordless cellular base station 10 does not have the minimum number of operating frequencies, it will send an alarm message to the cellular network 16. At this point, the cellular network will allow the cordless cellular base station 10 to operate with both sets of frequencies until Mj can be increased to n and the cordless cellular base station has enough cellular frequencies for operation. If the cordless cellular base station 10 has the required number of operating frequencies, the cellular network may remove the original "quick start frequencies" and allow it operate on the remaining ciear channels. It will remove the "quick start frequencies" during the next network update exchange using the authorization message. The authorization message will include only the second set of frequencies, i.e., excluding the "quick start frequencies," and a new M value equal to Mn-Mj. Local Frequency Monitor
As described above, the cordless cellular base station periodically initiates a phone call to the CCBS VLR. In a preferred embodiment, after initiation of the phone call, the cordless cellular base station 10 advantageously downloads all of the stored interference scores measured using the above described algorithm for all of its authorized frequencies. The CCBS VLR forwards the interference score information to a data collection node (DCN) in the cellular network.
In an alternate embodiment, the CCBS VLR periodically sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message with the telephone number for the data collection node instead of the telephone number for the location update information. The cordless cellular base station calls the new telephone number and reports the interference data directly to the data collection node. In one embodiment, after a specified period of time, during the next network contact between the CCBS and the network, the CCBS VLR sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message to reinstate the telephone number to report its location update messages. In another embodiment, the data collection node sends the cordless cellular base station a new authorization message to reinstate the telephone number of the CCBS VLR to report its location update messages. Advantageously, the cellular network can use these interference scores to assist in learning about the peak interference periods for the cell containing the CCBS. Further, the interference scores are useful in assigning or re¬ assigning the operational frequencies for the regional cells.
The present invention may be embodied in other specific forms without departing from its spirit or essential characteristics. The described embodiments are to be considered in all respects only as illustrative and not restrictive. The scope of the invention is, therefore, indicated by the appended claims rather than the foregoing description. All changes which come within the meaning and range of equivalency of the claims are to be embraced within their scope.

Claims

--58-WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:
1. A wireless communication system, comprising: a base station having a transceiver, said transceiver capable of establishing first and second audio voice channels; a first mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said first audio channel; and a second mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said second audio channel, wherein said first and second mobile stations are capable of establishing a communication link with each other through said base station.
2. The wireless communication system as in Claim 1, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiplex transceiver.
3. The wireless communication system as in Claim 2, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiple access transceiver.
4. A wireless communication system, comprising: a base station having a single transceiver, said transceiver capable of establishing first and second audio voice channels; a first mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said first audio channel; and a second mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said second audio channel, wherein each of said first and second mobile stations are capable of establishing a communication link with a third party through said base station.
5. The wireless communication system as in Claim 4, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiplex transceiver.
6. The wireless communication system as in Ciaim 5, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiple access transceiver.
7. A wireless communication system comprising: a base station having a transceiver, said transceiver capable of establishing first and second digital channels for transmitting digital data and messages; a first mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said first digital channel; and a second mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said second digital channel, wherein said first and second mobile stations are capable of establishing a communication link with each other through said base station.
8. The wireless communication system as in Claim 7, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiplex transceiver.
9. The wireless communication system as in Claim 8, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiple access transceiver.
10. A wireless communication system comprising: a base station having a single transceiver, said transceiver capable of establishing first and second digital channels for transmitting digital data and messages; a first mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said first digital channel; and a second mobile station adapted to communicate with said base station on said second digital channel, wherein each of said first and second mobile stations are capable of establishing a digital communication link with a third party through said base station.
11. The wireless communication system as in Claim 10, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiplex transceiver.
12. The wireless communication system as in Claim 11, wherein said transceiver is a time division multiple access transceiver.
13. A method of establishing communication between a subregional base station and a mobile station which is adapted for communication with a regional cellular network, comprising the steps of: maintaining a list in the mobile station of at least one subregional base station with which the mobile station had previously communicated, said list including information regarding the regional cellular service of a cell whose coverage area includes or is near the subregional base station and a list of channels on which a digital control channel for the subregional base station was previously located; determining if the cellular service for the cell in which the mobile station is currently operating matches the cellular service for a cell whose coverage area includes or is near one of the subregional base stations as indicated on said list; searching for a digital control channel of a subregional base station on each of the channels on which the digital control channel for the subregional base station was previously located from said list if the cell in which the mobile station is currently present matches the cell whose coverage area includes or is near one of the subregional base stations on said list; and establishing communication between the mobile station and the subregional base station, if the digital control channel of the subregional base station is located on one of the channels on which the subregional base station was previously located from said list.
14. A method of enabling communication between a wireless base station having a receiver and transmitter and at least one mobile station having a receiver and transmitter, comprising the steps of: storing a list of mobile station identification numbers in said wireless base station corresponding to mobile stations which have been granted registration privileges; traπsmitting a mobile station identification number from said at least one mobile station to the wireless base station when said at least one mobile station comes into proximity with said wireless base station; comparing the mobile station identification number received from the transmitting mobile station with each of the mobile station identification numbers in said list of mobile station identification numbers; and enabling communication between said at least one mobile station and said wireless base station if the mobile station identification number of said at least one mobile station matches one of the mobile station identification numbers in said list of mobile station identification numbers.
15. A base station having a receiver and transmitter for communicating with at least one mobile station having a receiver and transmitter, wherein said mobile station transmits a mobile station identification number which is received by the base station when said mobile station comes into proximity with base station, said base station comprising: a list of mobile station identification numbers stored in the base station corresponding to mobile stations which are currently granted registration privileges; a comparator adapted to compare the mobile station identification number received from the mobile station with each of said mobile station identification numbers on the list of mobile station identification numbers and to output a signal indicating whether a match occurred; and a transceiver in communication with said comparator, said transceiver adapted to process the communication from said mobile station to said base station when said comparator indicates that a match has occurred.
16. The base station of Claim 15, wherein said transceiver is a digital transceiver.
17. The base station of Claim 16, wherein said transceiver is a TDMA transceiver.
18. In a wireless communication system, a base station which records identifying information about a mobile station with which it has previously communicated, wherein said base station accepts a subsequent registration attempt by a mobile station without user intervention if the mobile station's identifying information matches this recorded value.
19. A method of collecting radio interference data in an active RF environment utilizing a wireless base station to collect the interference measurements, comprising the steps of: storing a list of frequencies and their respective interference measurement in said wireless base station; periodically measuring the interference on each of said frequencies; updating the interference measurements for said list of frequency with the periodic interference measurements; selecting an allowable operating frequency from the list of frequencies wherein said selected frequency has an interference measurement below a first threshold.
20. The method of collecting radio interference data of Claim 19, additionally comprising the step of: normalizing the interference measurement based upon the time interval between measurements for a given frequency.
21. A subregional base station in communication with a cellular network, said subregional base station capable of selecting its own operational frequency from a list of authorized frequencies, said subregional base station comprising: a frequency analyzer adapted to measure the interference on each frequency of said authorized frequency list; and a frequency selector in communication with said frequency analyzer adapted to select an operating frequency for said subregional base station based upon the interference measured by the frequency analyzer on each of said authorized frequencies.
22. The subregional base station of Claim 21, wherein said base station is using the method of Claim 49.
23. A method of measuring the interference at different frequencies on which a wireless base station having a transmitter and a receiver is operating in an environment having a potential noise problem, comprising the steps of: periodically halting the operation of said transmitter; tuning the receiver to a frequency for measurement; and measuring the interference on the frequency by detecting the signal strength at the receiver.
24. In a time-division multiplexed (TDM) or time-division multiple access (TDMA) wireless communication system, a base station which measures signal levels generated by other base stations, said base station includes a transmitter that ceases transmission periodically or quasi-pεriodically for an interval of time in order to make said measurements, wherein said interval is not required to support any remote unit that is communicating with the base station.
25. The base station of Claim 24, wherein the base station occasionally transmits during the interval normally used for said measurements.
26. The base station of Claim 25, wherein said occasional transmissions during the measurement interval are selected either randomly or according to an algorithm that produces a different pattern of said occasional transmissions for different base stations.
27. The base station of Claim 24, wherein the communication conforms to the IS-136 digital cellular standard, wherein a single time slot or portion of a single time slot is chosen as the interval for measurements.
28. A method of selecting the operating frequency of a wireless base station in communication with a subregional base station comprising the steps of: storing a list of allowable frequencies and a respective interference score in said wireless base station; periodically measuring the interference on each of said allowable frequencies; increasing said interference score by a first value if said interference measurement is above a first interference threshold and is below a second interference threshold; increasing said interference score by a second value which is greater than said first value if said interference measurement is above said second interference threshold; decreasing said interference score by a third value which is less than said first value if said interference measurement is below said first interference threshold; selecting an operating frequency from a group of frequencies on the list of allowable frequencies having an interference score below a first score threshold. generating a second list of frequencies from the list of allowable frequencies, wherein the frequencies on said second list have an interference score below a second score threshold; and enabling operation of said wireless base station when the number of frequencies on said second list equals or exceeds a minimum number of frequencies.
29. In a wireless communication system, a base station which selects its own operating channel from a multiplicity of permissible channels, wherein one or more other channels in addition to the operating channel are selected as backup channels, wherein the base station provides information on the selection of backup channels with its remotes, wherein, when the base station changes its operating channel, the base station moves to the first backup channel, with the second backup channel becoming the new first backup, and so on, wherein said selection of both operating and backup channels is based on a single numeric interference score for each permissible operating channel.
30. The base station of Claim 29, wherein said backup frequencies are selected on the basis of both interference scores and a random or pseudo-random number that is highly likely to be different for two different base stations that contain identical interference scores.
31. A time division multiplexed cellular communication channel, having a receive time frame and transmit time frame, said receive time frame comprising: a first time slot, wherein said first time slot receives digital control channel information; a second time slot, wherein said second time slot receives data regarding a first digital traffic channel; a third time slot, wherein said third time slot receives data regarding a second digital traffic channel; and a fourth time slot, wherein said fourth time slot receives interference information regarding the potential interference on the cellular communications channel.
32. The time division multiplexed cellular communication channel of Claim 31, wherein said receive time frame additionally comprises: a fifth time slot, wherein said fifth time slot receives data regarding said first digital traffic channel; and a sixth time slot, wherein said sixth time slot receives data regarding said second digital traffic channel.
33. A time division multiplexed cellular communication channel, said communications channel comprising a receive time frame and a transmit time frame, said transmit time frame comprising: a first time slot, wherein said first time slot transmits digital control channel information; a second time slot, wherein said second time slot transmits data regarding a first digital traffic channel; a third time slot, wherein said third time slot transmits data regarding a second digital traffi channel; and a fourth time slot, wherein said fourth time slot is occasionally silent to enable the measurement of the interference on the cellular communication channel.
34. The time division multiplexed cellular communication channel of Claim 33, wherein said transmit time frame additionally comprises: a fifth time slot, wherein said fifth time slot transmits data regarding said first digital traffic channel; and a sixth time slot, wherein said sixth time slot transmits data regarding said second digital traffic channel.
35. A time division multiplexed cellular communication channel of Claim 33, wherein said fourth time slot transmits an idle code when said interference measurement is not being made.
36. A time division multiplexed cellular communication channel, comprising: a receive time frame, said receive time frame comprising: a first receive time slot, wherein said first receive time slot receives digital control channel information, a second receive time slot, wherein said second receive time slot receives data regarding a first digital traffic channel. a third receive time slot, wherein said third receive time slot receives data regarding a second digital traffic channel, and a fourth receive time slot, wherein said fourth receive time slot receives interference information regarding the potential interference on the cellular communications channel; and a transmit time frame, said transmit time frame comprising: a first transmit time slot, wherein said first transmit time slot transmits digital control channel information, a second transmit time slot, wherein said second transmit time slot transmits data regarding a first digital traffic channel, a third transmit time slot, wherein said third transmit time slot transmits data regarding a second digital traffic channel, and a fourth transmit time slot, wherein said fourth transmit time slot is occasionally silent to enable the measurement of the interference on the cellular communication channel.
37. The time division multiplexed cellular communication channel of Claim 36, wherein said receive time frame additionally comprises: a fifth receive time slot, wherein said fifth receive time slot receives data regarding said first digital traffic channel, and a sixth receive time slot, wherein said sixth receive time slot receives data regarding said second digital traffic channel.
38. The time division multiplexed cellular communication channel of Claim 36, wherein said transmit time frame additionally comprises: a fifth transmit time slot, wherein said fifth transmit time slot transmits data regarding said first digital traffic channel, and a sixth transmit time slot, wherein said sixth transmit time slot transmits data regarding said second digital traffic channel.
39. A method of identifying a wireless regional cell formed by a regional base station within or near which a specified desired base station is likely to be located, wherein the wireless regional cellular device is part of a larger cellular system having multiple regional base stations and wherein a wireless mobile station is capable of communicating with the base stations of the regional cellular system and with the desired base station, said method comprising the steps of: providing a wireless mobile station with a cell identifier for at least one base station which forms a regional cell within or near which a specific desired base station is located; comparing the current operating frequency and operating characteristics of the regional base station forming the cell within which said wireless communication device is operating with said stored frequencies and operating characteristics; determining when said wireless communication device is in communication with a base station which corresponds to the at least one base station stored in said memory storage area; and said mobile station attempting to contact said desired base station when the mobile station is in communication with the matching regional base station and wherein the mobile station would not otherwise attempt to contact the desired base station.
40. A wireless communication device capable of communicating with a first plurality of base stations and a second plurality of sub-regional base stations, said wireless communication device comprising: a transceiver receiving from one of said second plurality of sub-regional base stations a list of operating frequencies and operating characteristics of nearby base stations belonging to said first plurality of base stations a memory storage area in communication with said transceiver, said memory storage area storing said operating frequencies and operating characteristics of said base stations which are proximal to said one of said second plurality of sub-regional base stations; and a processor in communication with said memory storage area, said processor comparing the current operating frequency and operating characteristics of said wireless communication device with said stored frequencies and operating characteristics of said base stations which are proximal to said one of said second plurality of sub-regional base stations, determining when said wireless communication device is in communication with a base station which is stored in said memory storage area and indicated being nearby to one of said second plurality of sub-regional base stations, and tuning said transceiver to attempt to locate said one of said second plurality of sub-regional base stations.
41. A mobile telecommunicating device for communicating wirelessly with a plurality of base stations of a first kind, in a first communication protocol, and for communicating wirelesslγ with at least a base station of a second kind, in a second communication protocol, wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind and said base station of said second kind transmits and receives wireless signals to and from a respective region, with a region of one base station of said first kind overlapping a region of said base station of said second kind, and wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind transmits a distinct identification signal, said device comprising: means for storing a first distinct identification signal transmitted by said one base station of said first kind; means for receiving each said distinct identification signal in said first protocol, from each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind, as said mobile telecommunication device travels through the respective regions of said plurality of base stations of said first kind; and means for comparing said distinct identification signal received by said device to said first distinct identification signal stored and to attempt to initiate communication in said second communication protocol in the event of a match.
42. The device of Claim 41, wherein said storing means further stores a second distinct identification signal, said second distinct identification signal transmitted by a base station of said first kind, whose associated region overlaps said region of said one base station of said first kind.
43. The device of Claim 42, wherein said receiving means receives a current distinct identification signal, said current distinct identification signal being a distinct identification signal currently received by said device.
44. The device of Claim 41, wherein said first communication protocol is in a first frequency.
45. The device of Claim 44, wherein said second communication protocol is in a second frequency, different from said first frequency.
46. The device of Ciaim 41, wherein said plurality of base stations of said first kind comprise a public carrier communication network.
47. The device of Claim 46, wherein said base station of said second kind comprises a non-public communication network.
48. The device of Claim 41, wherein said region of said base station of said second kind, overlapping with a plurality of regions of base stations of said first kind.
49. The device of Ciaim 48, wherein said storing means further stores a second distinct identification signal, said second distinct identification signal transmitted by another base station of said first kind, whose associated region overlaps said region of said base station of said second kind.
50. The device of Claim 49, wherein said comparing means further compares said distinct identification signal received by said device to said second distinct identification signal stored and to attempt to initiate communication with said base station of said second kind in the event of a match.
51. A method of changing wireless communication between a mobile unit and a first base station of a plurality of base stations of first kind, in a first communication protocol, and between said mobile unit and a base station of a second kind in a second communication protocoi, wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind and said base station of said second kind transmits and receives wireless signals to and from a respective region, with said region of said first base station of said first kind overlapping said region of said base station of said second kind, and wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind transmits a distinct identification signal, said method comprising: storing by said mobile unit, through user activation, a first distinct identification signal transmitted by said first base station of said first kind; receiving by said mobile unit each of said distinct identification signal in said first communication protocol, from each of said plurality of base stations of said first kind, as said mobile unit travels through the respective regions of said plurality of base stations of said first kind; and comparing said distinct identification signal received by said mobile unit to said first unique identification signal stored and to attempt to initiate communication in said communication protocol in the event of a match.
52. The method of Claim 51, further comprising storing a second distinct identification signal, said second distinct identification signal transmitted by a base station of said first kind, whose associated region overlaps said region of said first base station of said first kind.
53. The method of Claim 51, wherein said receiving step receives a current distinct identification signal, said current distinct identification signal being distinct identification signal currently received by said mobile unit.
54. The method of Claim 51, wherein said first communication protocol is in a first frequency.
55. The method of Claim 51, wherein said second communication protocol is in a second frequency, different from said first frequency.
56. The method of Ciaim 51, wherein said plurality of base stations of said first kind comprise a public carrier communication network.
57. The method of Claim 56, wherein said base station of said second kind comprises a non-public communication network.
58. The method of Claim 51, wherein said region of said base station of said second kind, overlapping with a plurality of regions of base stations of said first kind.
59. The method of Claim 58, wherein said storing step further stores a second distinct identification signal, said second distinct identification signal transmitted by a second base station of said first kind, whose associated region overlaps said region of said base station of said second kind.
60. The method of Claim 59, wherein said comparing step further compares said distinct identification signal received by said mobile unit to said second distinct identification signal stored and to attempt to initiate communication with said base station of said second kind in the event of a match.
61. A method of operating a portable communication device for switching communication between said device and two wireless systems, said method comprising: monitoring characteristic signals transmitted by one of said two wireless systems; storing characteristic signals of said one system, when a user activates switching in communication form said one system to another of said two wireless systems; communicating wirelessly with said one system, while monitoring characteristic signals thereof; comparing said characteristic signals monitored while communicating with said one system with said characteristic signals stored; and attempting to initiate communication automatically with said another system in the event of match in said comparing step.
62. The method of Claim 61, wherein communication with said first wireless system is in a first frequency.
63. The method of Claim 62, wherein communication with said second wireless system is in a second frequency, different from said first frequency.
64. The method of Claim 63, wherein said first wireless system is a public carrier communication system comprising a plurality of base stations each base station communicating within a cell.
65. The method of Claim 64, wherein said second wireless system is a non-public communication system comprising a base station communicating within a region.
66. The method of Ciaim 65, wherein a plurality of cells of said first wireless system overlap said region of said second system network.
67. The method of Claim 66, wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first wireless system transmits a distinct identification signal, with said characteristic signals being distinct identification signals.
68. A portable communication device for communicating wirelessly with two wireless networks, said device comprising: first transmitting means for communicating with one of said two wireless networks; second transmitting means for communicating with another of said two wireless networks; switch means interposed between said first transmitting means and a power source, and said second transmitting means and said power source; means for monitoring characteristic signals transmitted by said one network; means for storing characteristic signals of said one network when a user switches communication between said one network to said another network; means for comparing characteristic signals monitored by said monitoring means to characteristic signals stored in said storing means; and means for activating switch means automatically to cause communication with said another network, and to terminate communication with said one network in the event of a match in said comparing means.
69. The device of Claim 68, wherein said first wireless network is a public carrier communication network comprising a plurality of base stations each base station communicating within a cell.
70. The device of Ciaim 69, wherein said second wireless network is a non-public communication network comprising a base station communicating within a region.
71. The device of Claim 70, wherein communication with said first wireless network is in a first frequency.
72. The device of Claim 71, wherein communication with said second wireless network is in a second frequency, different from said first frequency.
73. The device of Claim 72, wherein a plurality of cells of said first wireless network overlap said region of said second wireless network.
74. The device of Claim 73, wherein each of said plurality of base stations of said first wireless network transmits a distinct identification signal, with said characteristic signals being distinct identification signals.
75. A mobile telecommunication unit, comprising: a wireless transceiver capable of communication with a first wireless system having a plurality of wireless base stations and an autonomous wireless system; a memory unit having a memory location therein to hold a base station identifier; a memory write unit that writes a base station identifier into said memory location when said mobile telecommunication unit switches from communication with the first wireless system to the autonomous wireless system.
76. In a wireless communication system, a mobile station which records information about a first base station with which it has previously communicated, wherein said information includes both the operating channel of said first base station and identifying characteristics of a second base station that is located near said first base station, wherein the mobile station checks the identifying characteristics of each base station that it encounters, wherein, when the mobile station encounters a base station whose characteristics match those of said second base station, the mobile station commences a search for said first base station, and wherein, when the mobile station locates said first base station, the mobile attempts to register with said first base station.
PCT/US1996/014019 1995-09-08 1996-08-30 Wireless communication system WO1997009835A1 (en)

Priority Applications (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CA002231255A CA2231255C (en) 1995-09-08 1996-08-30 Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station
EP96946386A EP0935893A4 (en) 1995-09-08 1996-08-30 Wireless communication system
JP9527157A JPH11512913A (en) 1995-09-08 1996-08-30 Wireless communication system

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US08/526,066 US5911120A (en) 1995-09-08 1995-09-08 Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station without using a landline or regional cellular network and without a call in progress
US08/526,066 1995-09-08

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO1997009835A1 true WO1997009835A1 (en) 1997-03-13

Family

ID=24095782

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US1996/014019 WO1997009835A1 (en) 1995-09-08 1996-08-30 Wireless communication system

Country Status (5)

Country Link
US (2) US5911120A (en)
EP (1) EP0935893A4 (en)
JP (1) JPH11512913A (en)
CA (2) CA2321957C (en)
WO (1) WO1997009835A1 (en)

Cited By (16)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1998018279A2 (en) * 1996-10-18 1998-04-30 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Mobile phone access method for public, private or home communication areas
WO1998036593A1 (en) * 1997-02-14 1998-08-20 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Method for supporting mobility management for a mobile communication terminal in a fixed network with communication terminal mobility
WO1998045894A2 (en) * 1997-04-08 1998-10-15 Northern Telecom Inc. Systems and methods for implementing private wireless communications
WO1999004585A1 (en) * 1997-07-16 1999-01-28 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system
EP0901299A2 (en) * 1997-09-08 1999-03-10 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Digital telecommunications device
WO1999014974A1 (en) * 1997-09-17 1999-03-25 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
EP0909103A1 (en) * 1997-09-16 1999-04-14 Ascom Business Systems Ag Method for operation of a radio system and system for implementing the method
EP0909104A1 (en) * 1997-09-16 1999-04-14 Ascom Business Systems Ag Method for the combined operation of a CT-system and a mobile radio system for implementing the method
WO2000019757A1 (en) * 1998-09-30 2000-04-06 Ericsson, Inc. Systems and methods for tracking of a private communication system subject to retuning
EP1101372A1 (en) * 1998-07-27 2001-05-23 GTE Wireless Service Corporation Method and apparatus for allowing cordless communication attempts in a multiple mode system
WO2002019750A1 (en) * 2000-09-01 2002-03-07 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) A system and a method for providing telecommunication services over either a fixed network or a mobile network depending on the location of the mobile terminal
US7203481B2 (en) 2002-02-07 2007-04-10 Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha Radio communication system with high security level, and communication unit and portable terminal used therefor
US7372827B2 (en) 2001-09-07 2008-05-13 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. Radio communication apparatus
EP2187698A1 (en) * 2007-08-13 2010-05-19 NTT DoCoMo, Inc. Mobile communication system, general base station device, base station device, and base station status control method
WO2010006289A3 (en) * 2008-07-11 2010-05-27 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
KR101452387B1 (en) * 2008-02-18 2014-10-23 삼성전자주식회사 Method and apparatus for managing spectrum in cognitive radio system supporing multi-channel operation

Families Citing this family (174)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7089034B1 (en) * 1994-09-20 2006-08-08 Telular Corp. Concurrent wireless/landline interface
US5911120A (en) * 1995-09-08 1999-06-08 At&T Wireless Services Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station without using a landline or regional cellular network and without a call in progress
US5675629A (en) * 1995-09-08 1997-10-07 At&T Cordless cellular system base station
JP3740231B2 (en) * 1996-11-19 2006-02-01 キヤノン株式会社 Wireless communication system and wireless communication device
US5995834A (en) * 1996-12-24 1999-11-30 At&T Wireless Services, Inc. Method for controlling channel re-selection from a selected control channel to an alternative control channel
US7149514B1 (en) 1997-07-30 2006-12-12 Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corp. Cellular docking station
US20080207197A1 (en) 1997-07-30 2008-08-28 Steven Tischer Apparatus, method, and computer-readable medium for interfacing devices with communications networks
KR100228911B1 (en) * 1997-08-14 1999-11-01 윤종용 Intercom method of tdma codeless phone
DE19742580C2 (en) * 1997-09-26 2000-12-28 Siemens Ag Communication terminal for wireless communication with transceiver base stations of different communication systems
US6694154B1 (en) * 1997-11-17 2004-02-17 Ericsson Inc. Method and apparatus for performing beam searching in a radio communication system
JP4352471B2 (en) * 1998-02-19 2009-10-28 ソニー株式会社 Communication system and communication method
BR9901010A (en) * 1998-03-16 2000-01-18 Ericsson Inc Process for registering a mobile station in a digital radio communication system and for determining whether or not to transmit a periodic registration signal from a mobile station to a base station, and a mobile communications device.
US6484027B1 (en) * 1998-06-15 2002-11-19 Sbc Technology Resources, Inc. Enhanced wireless handset, including direct handset-to-handset communication mode
US6304594B1 (en) * 1998-07-27 2001-10-16 General Dynamics Government Systems Corporation Interference detection and avoidance technique
KR100396643B1 (en) * 1998-09-07 2003-10-17 엘지전자 주식회사 Radio Packet Data Terminal
DE19843476C2 (en) * 1998-09-22 2001-12-20 Siemens Ag Method for radio coverage of a mobile terminal of a cellular network
US6606663B1 (en) * 1998-09-29 2003-08-12 Openwave Systems Inc. Method and apparatus for caching credentials in proxy servers for wireless user agents
US6389283B1 (en) * 1998-10-15 2002-05-14 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Release of remaining activities in VPLMNs
US6321097B1 (en) * 1998-10-26 2001-11-20 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Method for automatically switching modes in a dual mode cellular phone
US6493550B1 (en) * 1998-11-20 2002-12-10 Ericsson Inc. System proximity detection by mobile stations
DE19915548C2 (en) * 1999-04-07 2001-02-15 Plus Mobilfunk Gmbh E Method for combining landline and mobile telephony
US6804536B1 (en) * 1999-06-24 2004-10-12 Parkervision, Inc. Wireless communications interface
JP4334081B2 (en) * 1999-09-30 2009-09-16 株式会社東芝 Communication terminal and line connection method
FR2800553B1 (en) * 1999-10-27 2002-05-31 Sagem METHOD FOR MANAGING A BIMODE TELEPHONE
FR2804277B1 (en) * 2000-01-24 2002-04-12 Cit Alcatel SUBSCRIBER RADIOTELEPHONE TERMINAL EQUIPMENT AND TERMINALS FOR SUCH EQUIPMENT
US7990985B2 (en) * 2000-01-31 2011-08-02 3E Technologies International, Inc. Broadband communications access device
EP1284069B1 (en) * 2000-01-31 2004-11-10 Aeptec Microsystems, Inc. Broadband communications access device
US7382786B2 (en) * 2000-01-31 2008-06-03 3E Technologies International, Inc. Integrated phone-based home gateway system with a broadband communication device
US6944150B1 (en) * 2000-02-28 2005-09-13 Sprint Communications Company L.P. Method and system for providing services in communications networks
US20060072520A1 (en) * 2000-03-23 2006-04-06 Chitrapu Prabhakar R Time synchronized standby state to the GPRS medium access control protocol with applications to mobile satellite systems
US6430395B2 (en) * 2000-04-07 2002-08-06 Commil Ltd. Wireless private branch exchange (WPBX) and communicating between mobile units and base stations
US8363744B2 (en) 2001-06-10 2013-01-29 Aloft Media, Llc Method and system for robust, secure, and high-efficiency voice and packet transmission over ad-hoc, mesh, and MIMO communication networks
US6970719B1 (en) 2000-06-15 2005-11-29 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Private wireless network integrated with public wireless network
US7113492B2 (en) * 2001-02-07 2006-09-26 Siemens Communications Inc. Audio broadcast in cordless digital system
DE10038732A1 (en) * 2000-08-01 2002-02-14 Mannesmann Ag Method for providing information to the user of a mobile radio terminal
US6892068B2 (en) * 2000-08-02 2005-05-10 Mobile Satellite Ventures, Lp Coordinated satellite-terrestrial frequency reuse
US6859652B2 (en) 2000-08-02 2005-02-22 Mobile Satellite Ventures, Lp Integrated or autonomous system and method of satellite-terrestrial frequency reuse using signal attenuation and/or blockage, dynamic assignment of frequencies and/or hysteresis
EP1178693A1 (en) * 2000-08-03 2002-02-06 TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON (publ) Method for accessing a cellular telecommunication network
US6907023B2 (en) * 2000-08-14 2005-06-14 Vesuvius, Inc. Communique system with dynamic bandwidth allocation in cellular communication networks
US7024200B2 (en) * 2000-08-14 2006-04-04 Vesuvius, Inc. Communique system with active feedback for cellular communication networks
US6954641B2 (en) * 2000-08-14 2005-10-11 Vesivius, Inc. Communique wireless subscriber device for a cellular communication network
US6856807B1 (en) 2000-09-07 2005-02-15 Ericsson Inc. Method to control the update frequency of a positioning device by a mobile terminal
US7016667B1 (en) * 2000-09-18 2006-03-21 International Business Machines Corporation Wireless communications device and method for use with telephone network edge node providing bridging and privacy
US6801571B1 (en) * 2000-10-11 2004-10-05 Motorola, Inc. Method and apparatus for optimizing data compression in a wireless digital access system
JP3562459B2 (en) * 2000-10-17 2004-09-08 株式会社日立製作所 Mobile terminal device
US7792488B2 (en) 2000-12-04 2010-09-07 Atc Technologies, Llc Systems and methods for transmitting electromagnetic energy over a wireless channel having sufficiently weak measured signal strength
US20020068564A1 (en) * 2000-12-04 2002-06-06 Roger Gustavsson Systems and methods for reducing message overhead in a wireless communication network
US6766175B2 (en) 2000-12-13 2004-07-20 Waxess Technologies, Inc. Cordless and wireless telephone docking station
FR2818485B1 (en) * 2000-12-18 2003-03-28 Eads Defence & Security Ntwk RADIO RESOURCE ALLOCATION METHOD, BASE STATION FOR IMPLEMENTING SAME AND SYSTEM INCORPORATING SAME
JP2002199455A (en) * 2000-12-27 2002-07-12 Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd Cordless phone
EP1225775A1 (en) * 2001-01-19 2002-07-24 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Method and a device for telecommunication
US6885869B2 (en) * 2001-01-26 2005-04-26 Ericsson Inc. Method for mating a mobile terminal with a cordless phone system
EP1360855B1 (en) * 2001-02-06 2007-11-21 Nokia Corporation Access system for a cellular network
US6782266B2 (en) * 2001-08-31 2004-08-24 Motorola, Inc. Method of wireless communication in restricted wireless zones
US7245893B1 (en) * 2001-09-25 2007-07-17 Atheros Communications, Inc. Method and system for noise floor calibration and receive signal strength detection
KR100450961B1 (en) * 2001-09-28 2004-10-02 삼성전자주식회사 Apparatus and method for coincidence of subscriber status between public land mobile network and private network
US20040048610A1 (en) * 2001-09-28 2004-03-11 Kim Soo Hwan Method and system for matching subscriber states in network in which public land mobile network and wired/wireless private network are interworked
US20030092451A1 (en) * 2001-11-15 2003-05-15 Ibm Corporation Method of mobile phone consolidation
US20030104809A1 (en) * 2001-12-05 2003-06-05 Donald E. Godshaw Local wireless network system for cellular telephones
CN1204700C (en) * 2001-12-29 2005-06-01 联想(北京)有限公司 Radio communication system combining with long and short distance technology and its realizing method
US7133672B2 (en) 2002-01-08 2006-11-07 Motorola, Inc. Method and apparatus for registration of a mobile station in a packet data communication system
US20040203814A1 (en) * 2002-03-06 2004-10-14 Ho Lester Tse Wee Method of allocating channels to base stations in a telecommunications network, and a telecommunications network
US20040198327A1 (en) * 2002-04-22 2004-10-07 Mavis Bates Telecommunications call completion
US7398209B2 (en) * 2002-06-03 2008-07-08 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. Systems and methods for responding to natural language speech utterance
US20060128376A1 (en) * 2002-07-09 2006-06-15 Alexis Glenroy J Communication systems and methods
US8380879B2 (en) 2002-07-15 2013-02-19 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Interface devices for facilitating communications between devices and communications networks
US8543098B2 (en) 2002-07-15 2013-09-24 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for securely providing communications between devices and networks
US7693720B2 (en) * 2002-07-15 2010-04-06 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. Mobile systems and methods for responding to natural language speech utterance
US8533070B2 (en) * 2002-07-15 2013-09-10 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for aggregating and accessing data according to user information
US8275371B2 (en) * 2002-07-15 2012-09-25 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for providing communications and connection-oriented services to devices
US8416804B2 (en) 2002-07-15 2013-04-09 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for providing a user interface for facilitating communications between devices
US8554187B2 (en) 2002-07-15 2013-10-08 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for routing communications between networks and devices
US7200424B2 (en) 2002-07-15 2007-04-03 Bellsouth Intelectual Property Corporation Systems and methods for restricting the use and movement of telephony devices
US8526466B2 (en) * 2002-07-15 2013-09-03 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Apparatus and method for prioritizing communications between devices
US7313398B1 (en) * 2002-08-06 2007-12-25 Sprint Spectrum L.P. System and method for handoff in a CDMA network
US7366200B2 (en) * 2002-08-26 2008-04-29 Qualcomm Incorporated Beacon signaling in a wireless system
US7388845B2 (en) * 2002-08-26 2008-06-17 Qualcomm Incorporated Multiple access wireless communications system using a multisector configuration
US7133354B2 (en) * 2002-08-26 2006-11-07 Qualcomm Incorporated Synchronization techniques for a wireless system
US6985498B2 (en) * 2002-08-26 2006-01-10 Flarion Technologies, Inc. Beacon signaling in a wireless system
US20040102188A1 (en) * 2002-11-26 2004-05-27 Boyer David G. Automatic call forwarding on airplanes
US7295517B2 (en) * 2002-11-27 2007-11-13 Texas Instruments Incorporated Method and apparatus for channel quality metric generation within a packet-based multicarrier modulation communication system
US7626958B2 (en) * 2002-12-05 2009-12-01 The Boeing Company Serial port multiplexing protocol
US7269429B2 (en) * 2002-12-05 2007-09-11 The Boeing Company Communications protocol for mobile device
US7310533B2 (en) * 2002-12-05 2007-12-18 The Boeing Company Programmable messages for communication system having one-button user interface
US7299060B1 (en) 2002-12-10 2007-11-20 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Method and system for wireless bridging
US20040127203A1 (en) * 2002-12-26 2004-07-01 Nokia, Inc. Context sensitive call processing
US20040203680A1 (en) * 2003-04-08 2004-10-14 Nortel Networks Limited Integrated wireline and wireless service
US9042371B1 (en) 2003-04-10 2015-05-26 Rpx Clearinghouse Llc Integrating telephone lines with packet connections
JP4173405B2 (en) * 2003-05-29 2008-10-29 京セラ株式会社 Communication terminal out-of-range determination method, communication terminal
US20040266425A1 (en) * 2003-06-24 2004-12-30 Sbc, Inc. Wireless wide area network charger and cradle
US7616950B2 (en) * 2003-09-04 2009-11-10 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Call forwarding control device and method of call management
US20050064853A1 (en) * 2003-09-23 2005-03-24 Sbc Knowledge Ventures, L.P. Unified telephone handset for personal communications based on wireline and wireless network convergence
US8526977B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2013-09-03 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Location based call routing for call answering services
US7769392B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2010-08-03 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Method and system for forwarding wireless communications
US7123906B1 (en) * 2003-10-17 2006-10-17 Verizon Communications Inc. Integrated telephony service
US7577427B2 (en) * 2003-11-05 2009-08-18 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. System and method of transitioning between cellular and voice over internet protocol communication
US7142852B2 (en) * 2003-11-13 2006-11-28 Motorola, Inc. Method and gateway for controlling call routing
US9118574B1 (en) * 2003-11-26 2015-08-25 RPX Clearinghouse, LLC Presence reporting using wireless messaging
US20050143017A1 (en) * 2003-12-31 2005-06-30 Lopp Carl G. Docking station for enabling landline telephones to send/receive calls via a docked walkie-talkie-type mobile telephone
US20050143149A1 (en) * 2003-12-31 2005-06-30 Becker Christopher H. Telephone controller with intercom and paging functions and function for enabling landline telephones to send/receive calls via a mobile telephone
US6959172B2 (en) * 2003-12-31 2005-10-25 Christopher Henry Becker Docking station for enabling landline telephones to send/receive calls via a docked mobile telephone
US7480485B1 (en) 2004-01-07 2009-01-20 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Radio frequency repeater with automated block/channel selection
US7299005B1 (en) 2004-01-07 2007-11-20 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Radio frequency repeater with automated block/channel selection
US20050239496A1 (en) * 2004-04-14 2005-10-27 Nortel Networks Limited Mobile terminal with wired and wireless network interfaces
US20050277431A1 (en) * 2004-06-14 2005-12-15 Sbc Knowledge Ventures, Lp System and method for managing wireless data communications
US20060003806A1 (en) * 2004-07-02 2006-01-05 Sbc Knowledge Ventures, L.P. Phone synchronization device and method of handling personal information
US7580837B2 (en) 2004-08-12 2009-08-25 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. System and method for targeted tuning module of a speech recognition system
US7379446B2 (en) * 2004-10-14 2008-05-27 Qualcomm Incorporated Enhanced beacon signaling method and apparatus
US7715845B2 (en) 2004-10-14 2010-05-11 Qualcomm Incorporated Tone hopping methods and apparatus
US8032179B2 (en) * 2004-10-20 2011-10-04 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. System and method for making and receiving cellular telephone calls at a wired analog telephone device
US7242751B2 (en) 2004-12-06 2007-07-10 Sbc Knowledge Ventures, L.P. System and method for speech recognition-enabled automatic call routing
TWI252645B (en) * 2004-12-30 2006-04-01 Inventec Appliances Corp Method for automatically restoring the communication settings for mobile device
US7751551B2 (en) 2005-01-10 2010-07-06 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. System and method for speech-enabled call routing
US8325826B2 (en) * 2005-03-09 2012-12-04 Qualcomm Incorporated Methods and apparatus for transmitting signals facilitating antenna control
US7894807B1 (en) * 2005-03-30 2011-02-22 Openwave Systems Inc. System and method for routing a wireless connection in a hybrid network
US20060223511A1 (en) * 2005-04-05 2006-10-05 Hagale Anthony R System and method for call forwarding based on localized wireless identification
TWI258978B (en) * 2005-04-22 2006-07-21 Benq Corp Mobile communication system, mobile communication device and method for incoming-call filtering
US7657020B2 (en) 2005-06-03 2010-02-02 At&T Intellectual Property I, Lp Call routing system and method of using the same
US8005204B2 (en) 2005-06-03 2011-08-23 At&T Intellectual Property I, L.P. Call routing system and method of using the same
DE202005021930U1 (en) * 2005-08-01 2011-08-08 Corning Cable Systems Llc Fiber optic decoupling cables and pre-connected assemblies with toning parts
US7640160B2 (en) 2005-08-05 2009-12-29 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. Systems and methods for responding to natural language speech utterance
US7620549B2 (en) * 2005-08-10 2009-11-17 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method of supporting adaptive misrecognition in conversational speech
US7949529B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2011-05-24 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. Mobile systems and methods of supporting natural language human-machine interactions
EP1934971A4 (en) 2005-08-31 2010-10-27 Voicebox Technologies Inc Dynamic speech sharpening
US7848758B1 (en) 2005-09-27 2010-12-07 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Dynamic allocation of carrier frequencies in wireless wide area networks
WO2007040450A1 (en) 2005-10-04 2007-04-12 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Redirection of ip-connected radio base station to correct control node
US7589627B2 (en) * 2005-10-06 2009-09-15 Staccato Communications, Inc. Creation of environments to detect wireless devices
US7518524B1 (en) 2005-10-06 2009-04-14 Staccato Communications, Inc. Announcements to facilitate detection of wireless devices
US20070082633A1 (en) * 2005-10-06 2007-04-12 Staccato Communications, Inc. Avoidance of wireless devices
US20070165586A1 (en) * 2005-11-29 2007-07-19 Staccato Communications, Inc. Quiet periods for detecting wireless devices
WO2007064709A2 (en) * 2005-11-29 2007-06-07 Staccato Communications, Inc. Detecting wireless devices to inform about a quiet period
US8644286B2 (en) * 2006-02-14 2014-02-04 Broadcom Corporation Method and system for fast cell search using psync process in a multimode WCDMA terminal
JP4751735B2 (en) * 2006-02-15 2011-08-17 富士通株式会社 Communication link establishment method and communication link establishment program
JP2009530984A (en) * 2006-03-21 2009-08-27 スタッカート・コミュニケーションズ・インコーポレーテッド Exchange of detection and evasion information
US8351405B2 (en) * 2006-07-14 2013-01-08 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for signaling beacons in a communication system
US7623866B1 (en) 2006-07-10 2009-11-24 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Automatic generation of neighbor lists in a wireless network
US8225186B2 (en) 2006-07-14 2012-07-17 Qualcomm Incorporated Ecoding and decoding methods and apparatus for use in a wireless communication system
US8073681B2 (en) 2006-10-16 2011-12-06 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for a cooperative conversational voice user interface
US8971956B2 (en) * 2006-10-18 2015-03-03 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Method of providing neighbor information and method of generating neighbor location information
KR100816380B1 (en) 2006-10-26 2008-03-25 삼성전자주식회사 Method for managementing function of mobile terminal
US20080132239A1 (en) * 2006-10-31 2008-06-05 Amit Khetawat Method and apparatus to enable hand-in for femtocells
US20080119231A1 (en) * 2006-11-20 2008-05-22 Yeung Jun Kim Switchable divider and combiner assembly having multiple inputs and outputs
CN101198142B (en) * 2006-12-06 2010-06-09 中兴通讯股份有限公司 Load equalization method among frequency points of N frequency point cell
US7818176B2 (en) 2007-02-06 2010-10-19 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for selecting and presenting advertisements based on natural language processing of voice-based input
US20080268779A1 (en) * 2007-03-29 2008-10-30 Staccato Communications, Inc. DAA concept with uplink detection: frequency domain quiet periods
KR101398908B1 (en) * 2007-05-22 2014-05-26 삼성전자주식회사 Method and system for managing mobility in mobile telecommunication system using mobile ip
US8346315B2 (en) * 2007-09-10 2013-01-01 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Power-aware selection of radio access technology
US20090092093A1 (en) * 2007-10-03 2009-04-09 Hong Kong Applied Science and Technology Research Institute Company Limited Handoff of dual mode mobile device between an IP network and a PLMN
US8140335B2 (en) 2007-12-11 2012-03-20 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for providing a natural language voice user interface in an integrated voice navigation services environment
US8335188B1 (en) * 2008-05-19 2012-12-18 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Method and system for handoffs between public and private wireless networks
US8589161B2 (en) 2008-05-27 2013-11-19 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for an integrated, multi-modal, multi-device natural language voice services environment
US9305548B2 (en) 2008-05-27 2016-04-05 Voicebox Technologies Corporation System and method for an integrated, multi-modal, multi-device natural language voice services environment
US8989172B2 (en) * 2008-07-22 2015-03-24 Kyocera Corporation Data routing through local network connected to a base station
US8326637B2 (en) 2009-02-20 2012-12-04 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for processing multi-modal device interactions in a natural language voice services environment
US8498241B1 (en) 2009-03-10 2013-07-30 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Use of macro-network channel-list messages for selection of carriers for low-cost internet base-station frequency-hopping pilot beacons
US8060100B1 (en) * 2009-04-07 2011-11-15 Sprint Communications Company L.P. Neighbor list control for a wireless communication system
US8325648B1 (en) 2009-04-29 2012-12-04 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Methods and systems for assigning a wireless communication device to a carrier frequency
US8320313B1 (en) 2009-06-19 2012-11-27 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Method and system for carrier frequency management based on slot contention
US8611895B2 (en) * 2009-10-30 2013-12-17 Apple Inc. Methods for optimizing paging mechanisms using device context information
US9171541B2 (en) 2009-11-10 2015-10-27 Voicebox Technologies Corporation System and method for hybrid processing in a natural language voice services environment
WO2011059997A1 (en) 2009-11-10 2011-05-19 Voicebox Technologies, Inc. System and method for providing a natural language content dedication service
US9107148B1 (en) 2009-11-30 2015-08-11 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Use of pre-handoff macro-carrier data for prioritization of carriers in femtocell frequency-hopping pilot beacons
US9563751B1 (en) 2010-10-13 2017-02-07 The Boeing Company License utilization management system service suite
US8769299B1 (en) 2010-10-13 2014-07-01 The Boeing Company License utilization management system license wrapper
US8798013B1 (en) 2011-03-25 2014-08-05 Sprint Spectrum L.P. Method and system for management of data transmission in timeslots
JP5817635B2 (en) * 2012-04-20 2015-11-18 コニカミノルタ株式会社 Data communication system and radiographic imaging system
WO2016044290A1 (en) 2014-09-16 2016-03-24 Kennewick Michael R Voice commerce
WO2016044321A1 (en) 2014-09-16 2016-03-24 Min Tang Integration of domain information into state transitions of a finite state transducer for natural language processing
CN107003999B (en) 2014-10-15 2020-08-21 声钰科技 System and method for subsequent response to a user's prior natural language input
US10431214B2 (en) 2014-11-26 2019-10-01 Voicebox Technologies Corporation System and method of determining a domain and/or an action related to a natural language input
US10614799B2 (en) 2014-11-26 2020-04-07 Voicebox Technologies Corporation System and method of providing intent predictions for an utterance prior to a system detection of an end of the utterance
US10331784B2 (en) 2016-07-29 2019-06-25 Voicebox Technologies Corporation System and method of disambiguating natural language processing requests
US10912282B2 (en) * 2016-09-07 2021-02-09 Smart Tracking Technologies, Llc Smart animal collar system
US9894211B1 (en) * 2017-07-05 2018-02-13 Republic Wireless, Inc. Techniques for enhanced call routing for groups

Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5191593A (en) * 1991-05-31 1993-03-02 Motorola, Inc. Conference call feature for spread spectrum cordless telephone
US5228026A (en) * 1989-01-27 1993-07-13 British Telecommunications Public Limited Company Technique for time-division duplex cordless telecommunication
US5263045A (en) * 1990-12-05 1993-11-16 Interdigital Technology Corporation Spread spectrum conference call system and method
US5533027A (en) * 1993-02-16 1996-07-02 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Digital fixed radio access system providing local mobility

Family Cites Families (107)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB1183439A (en) * 1968-07-11 1970-03-04 Standard Telephones Cables Ltd Subscriber Subset for PCM Telephone System
US4086442A (en) * 1976-04-28 1978-04-25 Rickard Bryan W Repertory diallers
US4313035A (en) * 1980-01-18 1982-01-26 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated Method of providing person locator service
US4392220A (en) 1980-05-30 1983-07-05 Nippon Electric Co., Ltd. Modem to be coupled to a directional transmission line of an SS multiplex communication network
FR2527871B1 (en) 1982-05-27 1986-04-11 Thomson Csf RADIOCOMMUNICATION SYSTEM, FREQUENCY HOPPING
US4508937A (en) * 1983-02-28 1985-04-02 At&T Information Systems Inc. Method and circuitry for encoding telephone ringing signals
GB8419003D0 (en) * 1984-07-25 1984-08-30 Racal Res Ltd Portable telephones
US4675863A (en) 1985-03-20 1987-06-23 International Mobile Machines Corp. Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels
FR2584884B1 (en) 1985-07-09 1987-10-09 Trt Telecom Radio Electr FREE CHANNEL SEARCHING METHOD AND DEVICE FOR A MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM
JPH0746877B2 (en) 1985-12-11 1995-05-17 株式会社日立製作所 Mobile radio communication system
US4752951A (en) * 1985-12-23 1988-06-21 Konneker Lloyd K Method of providing location dependent person locator service
US5210786A (en) 1986-10-15 1993-05-11 Iwatsu Electric Co. Ltd. Portable telephone system using stratified exchange system
US6167278A (en) 1986-10-22 2000-12-26 Nilssen; Ole K. Combination cordless-cellular telephone system
US4831647A (en) 1987-06-02 1989-05-16 Motorola, Inc. Radiotelephone credit card data communications
US4905302A (en) 1987-06-03 1990-02-27 General Electric Company Trunked radio repeater system
US4797948A (en) * 1987-07-22 1989-01-10 Motorola, Inc. Vehicle identification technique for vehicle monitoring system employing RF communication
US5210785A (en) * 1988-02-29 1993-05-11 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Wireless communication system
US5367558A (en) * 1988-09-23 1994-11-22 Motorola, Inc. Cellular cordless telephone
US4989230A (en) * 1988-09-23 1991-01-29 Motorola, Inc. Cellular cordless telephone
US5127042A (en) * 1988-09-23 1992-06-30 Motorola, Inc. Cellular cordless telephone
US4977589A (en) 1988-11-25 1990-12-11 Motorola, Inc. Signalling and control protocol for a communication system
US4953197A (en) * 1988-12-08 1990-08-28 International Mobile Machines Corporation Combination spatial diversity system
GB2236454A (en) * 1989-09-01 1991-04-03 Philips Electronic Associated Communications system for radio telephones
US5020091A (en) 1989-12-26 1991-05-28 Motorola Inc. Automatic new radiotelephone system registration notification
FR2658934B1 (en) 1990-02-28 1992-04-30 Bull Sa SYSTEM ARCHITECTURE AND USE OF THIS ARCHITECTURE IN A CARD REPLACEMENT METHOD.
US5471649A (en) 1990-03-31 1995-11-28 Motorola, Inc. Base station transceiver diagnostic equipment
US5197093A (en) 1990-04-13 1993-03-23 Phonemate, Inc. Enviromental adaptive mechanism for channel utilization in cordless telephones
US5418839A (en) * 1990-04-13 1995-05-23 Phonemate, Inc. Environmental adaptive mechanism for channel utilization in cordless telephones
US5428687A (en) 1990-06-08 1995-06-27 James W. Fosgate Control voltage generator multiplier and one-shot for integrated surround sound processor
US5425030A (en) 1990-06-29 1995-06-13 Motorola Inc. On-site system frequency sharing with trunking system
JP2814297B2 (en) * 1990-08-07 1998-10-22 松下電器産業株式会社 Wireless telephone equipment
DE4029528A1 (en) * 1990-09-18 1992-03-19 Philips Patentverwaltung TELEPHONE FOR A SERVICE-INTEGRATED DIGITAL NEWS NETWORK (ISDN)
US5197092A (en) * 1990-10-31 1993-03-23 Mccaw Cellular Communications, Inc. Location registration system for a personal communicator such as a cellular telephone
US5224120A (en) 1990-12-05 1993-06-29 Interdigital Technology Corporation Dynamic capacity allocation CDMA spread spectrum communications
US5161168A (en) * 1991-05-15 1992-11-03 Scs Mobilecom, Inc. Spread spectrum CDMA communications system microwave overlay
US5513176A (en) 1990-12-07 1996-04-30 Qualcomm Incorporated Dual distributed antenna system
US5287550A (en) 1990-12-24 1994-02-15 Motorola, Inc. Simulcast scheduler
US5193101A (en) 1991-02-04 1993-03-09 Motorola, Inc. On-site system frequency sharing with trunking systems using spread spectrum
US5239538A (en) 1991-02-22 1993-08-24 Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications, Inc. Controller architecture for rf trunking distributed multisite switch
US5504936A (en) * 1991-04-02 1996-04-02 Airtouch Communications Of California Microcells for digital cellular telephone systems
JP2653000B2 (en) 1991-04-24 1997-09-10 日本電気株式会社 Mobile wireless communication system
US5127661A (en) * 1991-04-25 1992-07-07 Parker Hannifin Corporation Fluid seal
US5388149A (en) * 1991-06-03 1995-02-07 At&T Corp. Method and apparatus for determining availability of a public base unit for communicating with a cordless telephone in a public cordless telephone system
US5241537A (en) 1991-06-04 1993-08-31 Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications, Inc. Conventional base station interface architecture for RF trunking multisite switch
US5210784A (en) 1991-06-28 1993-05-11 Lifeline Systems, Inc. Adaptive speakerphone system
US5210771A (en) 1991-08-01 1993-05-11 Motorola, Inc. Multiple user spread-spectrum communication system
US5289527A (en) 1991-09-20 1994-02-22 Qualcomm Incorporated Mobile communications device registration method
US5621784A (en) 1991-09-20 1997-04-15 Qualcomm Incorporated Comprehensive mobile communications device registration method
US5287544A (en) 1991-10-17 1994-02-15 Motorola, Inc. Method of channel assignment by matching channel interference with channel link loss
DE69231118T2 (en) 1991-10-18 2000-12-14 Fujitsu Ltd., Kawasaki Message distribution system with cordless message-transmitting substations and message-receiving terminal devices
JP2643689B2 (en) * 1991-10-21 1997-08-20 松下電器産業株式会社 Channel allocation method in microcellular system
US5504803A (en) * 1991-11-25 1996-04-02 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. Method for automatic mode selection for a dual-mode telephone handset for use in a cellular mobile telephone system and in a wireless telephone system
EP0544095B1 (en) 1991-11-25 2000-03-01 Motorola, Inc. Reduced interference through frequency partitioning in cellular comunnication systems
US5513248A (en) * 1991-12-02 1996-04-30 At&T Corp. Cordless telephone micro-cellular system
EP0545581B1 (en) 1991-12-06 1999-04-21 National Semiconductor Corporation Integrated data processing system including CPU core and parallel, independently operating DSP module
US5592490A (en) 1991-12-12 1997-01-07 Arraycomm, Inc. Spectrally efficient high capacity wireless communication systems
US5353331A (en) * 1992-03-05 1994-10-04 Bell Atlantic Network Services, Inc. Personal communications service using wireline/wireless integration
JPH05308323A (en) 1992-04-30 1993-11-19 Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd Radio telephone system
US5559866A (en) 1992-06-01 1996-09-24 Motorola, Inc. Method of reuse through remote antenna and same channel cell division
US5361399A (en) 1992-06-02 1994-11-01 Pagemart, Inc. Adaptive communication system for transmitting between base stations and portable transceivers via different data rate communication links
CA2115657C (en) * 1992-06-23 1998-07-07 Michael J. Schellinger Dual system cellular cordless radiotelephone apparatus with sub-data channel timing monitor
AU670955B2 (en) 1992-08-04 1996-08-08 Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. Mobile radio system
JPH06165242A (en) * 1992-10-26 1994-06-10 Philips Electron Nv Communication system
DE4236982A1 (en) 1992-11-02 1994-05-05 Philips Patentverwaltung Cellular mobile radio system
US5570349A (en) * 1994-06-07 1996-10-29 Stanford Telecommunications, Inc. Wireless direct sequence spread spectrum digital cellular telephone system
US5497503A (en) 1993-05-28 1996-03-05 Ameritech Corporation Method for assigning frequency channels in a cellular communication system and for identifying critical existing fixed microwave receivers that restrict operation of such a system
EP0661837A4 (en) 1993-06-17 1999-03-24 Toshiba Kk Mobile radio communication system and fixed and mobile units used therefor.
CN1062105C (en) * 1993-08-02 2001-02-14 松下电器产业株式会社 A personal communications system with automatic mode selection
US5406615A (en) 1993-08-04 1995-04-11 At&T Corp. Multi-band wireless radiotelephone operative in a plurality of air interface of differing wireless communications systems
US5581594A (en) 1993-09-13 1996-12-03 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for initiating communication via paging a mobile computing device
JPH07143056A (en) 1993-09-24 1995-06-02 Hitachi Ltd Mobile object communication equipment
DE4335031A1 (en) 1993-10-14 1995-04-20 Sel Alcatel Ag Mobile network and conference service facility therefor
US6021333A (en) 1993-11-01 2000-02-01 Omnipoint Corporation Method and system for transferring information within a mobile communication system
US5812955A (en) 1993-11-04 1998-09-22 Ericsson Inc. Base station which relays cellular verification signals via a telephone wire network to verify a cellular radio telephone
US5428668A (en) 1993-11-04 1995-06-27 Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications Inc. Radio personal communications system and method for allocating frequencies for communications between a cellular terminal and a base station
US5544222A (en) 1993-11-12 1996-08-06 Pacific Communication Sciences, Inc. Cellular digtial packet data mobile data base station
IT1261365B (en) 1993-12-02 1996-05-20 Cselt Centro Studi Lab Telecom PROCEDURE AND DEVICE FOR THE POWER CONTROL IN THE MOBILE BASE-HALF STATION ROUTE OF A RADIO-MOBILE SYSTEM WITH ACCESS TO CODE DIVISION
GB9402942D0 (en) 1994-02-16 1994-04-06 Northern Telecom Ltd Base station antenna arrangement
US5594782A (en) * 1994-02-24 1997-01-14 Gte Mobile Communications Service Corporation Multiple mode personal wireless communications system
US5469115A (en) 1994-04-28 1995-11-21 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for automatic gain control in a digital receiver
ZA95605B (en) 1994-04-28 1995-12-20 Qualcomm Inc Method and apparatus for automatic gain control and dc offset cancellation in quadrature receiver
US5509052A (en) 1994-05-25 1996-04-16 Motorola, Inc. Base storage of handset's base registrations
US5574979A (en) 1994-06-03 1996-11-12 Norand Corporation Periodic interference avoidance in a wireless radio frequency communication system
US5570367A (en) 1994-07-29 1996-10-29 Lucent Technologies Inc. Asymmetric protocol for wireless communications
JPH0856378A (en) 1994-08-12 1996-02-27 Saitama Nippon Denki Kk Mobile object packet communication system
US5602903A (en) 1994-09-28 1997-02-11 Us West Technologies, Inc. Positioning system and method
US5745850A (en) 1994-10-24 1998-04-28 Lucent Technologies, Inc. Apparatus and method for mobile (e.g. cellular or wireless) telephone call handover and impersonation
US5629976A (en) * 1995-01-23 1997-05-13 Motorola Inc TELCO-less CT-2 base
US5577103A (en) 1995-03-10 1996-11-19 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Method of providing service information to subscribers in a cellular telecommunications network using the short message service (SMS)
US5592480A (en) 1995-03-13 1997-01-07 Carney; Ronald R. Wideband wireless basestation making use of time division multiple-access bus having selectable number of time slots and frame synchronization to support different modulation standards
US5722070A (en) 1995-04-12 1998-02-24 Uniden America Corporation Cell of preference check in a communications network
US5535215A (en) 1995-05-01 1996-07-09 Motorola, Inc. Method and apparatus for providing control channels and message channels in a radio communication system
ZA958218B (en) 1995-07-24 1996-04-24 Telular Int Inc Self-diagnostic system for cellular-transceiver systems with remote-reporting capabilities
US5926760A (en) 1995-07-31 1999-07-20 Lucent Technologies, Inc. System for providing features for a land-line supported private base station operable in a cellular system
US5966668A (en) 1995-09-01 1999-10-12 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Methods for handling reconfiguration of radio base stations in radio local loop systems
US5911120A (en) * 1995-09-08 1999-06-08 At&T Wireless Services Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station without using a landline or regional cellular network and without a call in progress
US5675629A (en) 1995-09-08 1997-10-07 At&T Cordless cellular system base station
US5768267A (en) * 1995-10-18 1998-06-16 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Method for system registration and cell reselection
US5715516A (en) 1995-10-18 1998-02-03 Cellular Telecom, Ltd. Method and apparatus for wireless communication employing collector arrays
JP3274337B2 (en) 1995-12-27 2002-04-15 株式会社東芝 CDMA cellular radio system
US6101176A (en) 1996-07-24 2000-08-08 Nokia Mobile Phones Method and apparatus for operating an indoor CDMA telecommunications system
US5995839A (en) 1996-08-20 1999-11-30 Southwestern Bell Technology Resources, Inc. Private radiotelephone system with enhanced telephone system interface
US6236365B1 (en) * 1996-09-09 2001-05-22 Tracbeam, Llc Location of a mobile station using a plurality of commercial wireless infrastructures
US5933774A (en) 1996-10-31 1999-08-03 Lucent Technologies Inc. Location registering apparatus for use with a cellular telephone mobile station
US6088598A (en) 1996-12-17 2000-07-11 Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson Method and system for displaying greetings in a mobile radio communications system
US6112098A (en) 1997-11-26 2000-08-29 International Business Machines Corporation Cordless or wireless system protocol for providing reliable channel connections
US6484027B1 (en) * 1998-06-15 2002-11-19 Sbc Technology Resources, Inc. Enhanced wireless handset, including direct handset-to-handset communication mode

Patent Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5228026A (en) * 1989-01-27 1993-07-13 British Telecommunications Public Limited Company Technique for time-division duplex cordless telecommunication
US5263045A (en) * 1990-12-05 1993-11-16 Interdigital Technology Corporation Spread spectrum conference call system and method
US5191593A (en) * 1991-05-31 1993-03-02 Motorola, Inc. Conference call feature for spread spectrum cordless telephone
US5533027A (en) * 1993-02-16 1996-07-02 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Digital fixed radio access system providing local mobility

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See also references of EP0935893A4 *

Cited By (39)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1998018279A3 (en) * 1996-10-18 1998-11-05 Siemens Ag Mobile phone access method for public, private or home communication areas
WO1998018279A2 (en) * 1996-10-18 1998-04-30 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Mobile phone access method for public, private or home communication areas
WO1998036593A1 (en) * 1997-02-14 1998-08-20 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Method for supporting mobility management for a mobile communication terminal in a fixed network with communication terminal mobility
WO1998045894A3 (en) * 1997-04-08 1999-03-11 Northern Telecom Inc Systems and methods for implementing private wireless communications
US6219539B1 (en) 1997-04-08 2001-04-17 Nortel Networks Corporation Systems and methods for implementing private wireless communications
WO1998045894A2 (en) * 1997-04-08 1998-10-15 Northern Telecom Inc. Systems and methods for implementing private wireless communications
KR100547088B1 (en) * 1997-07-16 2006-01-26 텔레폰악티에볼라겟엘엠에릭슨(펍) System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system
AU745471B2 (en) * 1997-07-16 2002-03-21 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system
WO1999004585A1 (en) * 1997-07-16 1999-01-28 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system
US6044268A (en) * 1997-07-16 2000-03-28 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Ab System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system
EP0901299A2 (en) * 1997-09-08 1999-03-10 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Digital telecommunications device
EP0901299A3 (en) * 1997-09-08 2002-06-19 Infineon Technologies AG Digital telecommunications device
EP0909104A1 (en) * 1997-09-16 1999-04-14 Ascom Business Systems Ag Method for the combined operation of a CT-system and a mobile radio system for implementing the method
US6356762B1 (en) 1997-09-16 2002-03-12 Ascom Business Systems Ag Method for the operation of a radio system and system to execute the method
EP0909103A1 (en) * 1997-09-16 1999-04-14 Ascom Business Systems Ag Method for operation of a radio system and system for implementing the method
GB2346048A (en) * 1997-09-17 2000-07-26 Ericsson Telefon Ab L M Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
US6058302A (en) * 1997-09-17 2000-05-02 Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
AU742329B2 (en) * 1997-09-17 2001-12-20 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
GB2346048B (en) * 1997-09-17 2002-06-05 Ericsson Telefon Ab L M Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
WO1999014974A1 (en) * 1997-09-17 1999-03-25 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Limiting access to private networks in cellular communications systems
EP1101372A1 (en) * 1998-07-27 2001-05-23 GTE Wireless Service Corporation Method and apparatus for allowing cordless communication attempts in a multiple mode system
EP1101372A4 (en) * 1998-07-27 2001-10-24 Gte Wireless Service Corp Method and apparatus for allowing cordless communication attempts in a multiple mode system
JP2002521985A (en) * 1998-07-27 2002-07-16 ジーティーイー ワイヤレス サービス コーポレイション Method and apparatus for enabling cordless communication attempts in a dual mode system
WO2000019757A1 (en) * 1998-09-30 2000-04-06 Ericsson, Inc. Systems and methods for tracking of a private communication system subject to retuning
US6418313B1 (en) 1998-09-30 2002-07-09 Ericsson Inc. Systems and methods for tracking of a private communication system subject to retuning
WO2002019750A1 (en) * 2000-09-01 2002-03-07 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) A system and a method for providing telecommunication services over either a fixed network or a mobile network depending on the location of the mobile terminal
US7043248B2 (en) 2000-09-01 2006-05-09 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) System and method for providing telecommunication services
US8300576B2 (en) 2001-09-07 2012-10-30 Panasonic Corporation Radio communication apparatus
US7372827B2 (en) 2001-09-07 2008-05-13 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. Radio communication apparatus
US7203481B2 (en) 2002-02-07 2007-04-10 Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha Radio communication system with high security level, and communication unit and portable terminal used therefor
EP2187698A1 (en) * 2007-08-13 2010-05-19 NTT DoCoMo, Inc. Mobile communication system, general base station device, base station device, and base station status control method
EP2187698A4 (en) * 2007-08-13 2015-03-18 Ntt Docomo Inc Mobile communication system, general base station device, base station device, and base station status control method
KR101452387B1 (en) * 2008-02-18 2014-10-23 삼성전자주식회사 Method and apparatus for managing spectrum in cognitive radio system supporing multi-channel operation
CN102090109A (en) * 2008-07-11 2011-06-08 高通股份有限公司 Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
WO2010006289A3 (en) * 2008-07-11 2010-05-27 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
KR101207536B1 (en) 2008-07-11 2012-12-04 콸콤 인코포레이티드 Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
US8428016B2 (en) 2008-07-11 2013-04-23 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
CN102090109B (en) * 2008-07-11 2014-06-18 高通股份有限公司 Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario
US9497732B2 (en) 2008-07-11 2016-11-15 Qualcomm Incorporated Method and apparatus for communicating in a dominant interference scenario

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US6735432B1 (en) 2004-05-11
CA2321957C (en) 2005-02-08
EP0935893A1 (en) 1999-08-18
CA2321957A1 (en) 1997-03-13
CA2231255C (en) 2004-09-14
MX9801827A (en) 1998-08-30
US5911120A (en) 1999-06-08
EP0935893A4 (en) 2000-05-31
JPH11512913A (en) 1999-11-02
CA2231255A1 (en) 1997-03-13

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US5911120A (en) Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station without using a landline or regional cellular network and without a call in progress
US5675629A (en) Cordless cellular system base station
CA2386746C (en) Method of operating a radiocommunications system
US5887259A (en) Multiple mode personal wireless communications system
US20080058005A1 (en) System and method of telephonic dialing simulation
MXPA98001827A (en) Inalambr communication system

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): CA MX

DFPE Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed before 20040101)
DFPE Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed before 20040101)
CFP Corrected version of a pamphlet front page
CR1 Correction of entry in section i

Free format text: PAT.BUL.12/97 UNDER INID (81) "DESIGNATED STATES", ADD "JP, EUROPEAN PATENT(AT,BE,CH,DE,DK,ES,FI,FR,GB,GR,IE,IT,LU,MC,NL,PT,SE)";DUE TO LATE TRANSMITTAL BY THE RECEIVING OFFICE

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2231255

Country of ref document: CA

Ref country code: CA

Ref document number: 2231255

Kind code of ref document: A

Format of ref document f/p: F

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: PA/a/1998/001827

Country of ref document: MX

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref country code: JP

Ref document number: 1997 527157

Kind code of ref document: A

Format of ref document f/p: F

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 1996946386

Country of ref document: EP

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 1996946386

Country of ref document: EP